Friday, February 5, 2010

Astral

Adventures Beyond the Body
HOW TO EXPERIENCE OUT-OF-BODY TRAVEL
William Buhlman
"An intriguing guidebook for those who want to venture beyond the horizon of
ordinary reality." --Raymond Moody, author of Life After Life
***
Explore new worlds without booking a flight! In Adventures Beyond the Body,
William Buhlman recounts his fascinating experiences with astral travel, connects
this phenomenon with current cosmological theories, and suggests that we all have
the capability to travel to parallel universes. Don't worry about getting lost--
Adventures is filled with well mapped methods for finding your way out of your
body and into other worlds. Control is Buhlman's mantra, specifically control over
our fear of the unknown. He precisely addresses the common events that can occur
during an out-of-body experience, taking the fear out of the journey, and allowing
you to focus on living the adventure. --Brian Patterson
***
Explore New Worlds . . .
If you ever wondered what might lie beyond the reality we experience every day, if
you've ever thrilled to accounts of out-of-body travel and longer to go alone for the
ride, this fascinating, practical guide is for you. America's leading expert on out-ofbody
travel tells the riveting story of his travels to other realms and offers easy-touse
techniques to guide you on your journey of a lifetime, and beyond.
Travel into Parallel Realities . . .
William Buhlman has trained out-of-body travelers in his workshop for more than a
decade, teaching people how to project their consciousness outside the limits of
their physical bodies and to explore dimensions and worlds beyond everyday life.
Now he vividly recounts how own adventures in the parallel universe described in
the new-physics theories of Stephen Hawkins, Paul Davies, and Fred Alan Wolf and
presents his step-by-step guide to astral travel, including exercises, tips,
techniques, and answers to your every question about out-of-body experiences.
And discover surprising Truths about Reality, Past Lives, the Soul, and Life
after Death.
Astral travel, Buhlman reveals, not only can expand your consciousness, it can help
verify the existence of the soul, teach you about past lives, and enhance your daily
life. Find out in this compelling handbook for everyone who wants to venture
beyond the body and take the ultimate trip.
Author William Buhlman teaches and lectures widely on out-of-body travel. He is a
frequent guest on the nationally syndicated radio shows Coast to Coast A.M. and
Dreamland, and has been featured on the national television show Sightings. Visit
the author online at www.out-of-body.com [Book Description from the publisher].
Adventures Beyond the Body
HOW TO EXPERIENCE OUT-OF-BODY TRAVEL
William Buhlman
Contents
Preface
Acknowledgements (not in this Ebook)
Part 1 – Exploring the Mysterious
1 First Journeys
2 Meetings Out-of-Body
Part 2 – Solving our great Mysteries
3 The New Frontier
4 Transformative Qualities
5 Developing your Natural Ability
6 Exploration Techniques
7 Mastering the Experience
8 Advanced Explorations
Conclusion
Glossary
Out-of-Body Survey
Index (not in this Ebook)
Permissions
Preface
Five hundred years ago, a few courageous explorers crossed an ocean in search of
a new land—a mysterious land hidden by an unexplored and uncharted ocean.
Many people considered this journey a waste of time and resources. After all,
modern civilization had flourished for centuries without this kind of exploration.
Against all odds this handful of explorers ventured forward, their burning desire for
discovery propelling them into the unknown. They abandoned the comforts of home
to embark on a journey beyond the known horizons. Facing both their own and
society’s fears and doubts, they continued their course, finally achieving their goal
of discovery.
Today we face the same kind of exploration—an unexplored ocean of energy
waiting to be conquered by individuals who possess the foresight and courage to go
beyond the limits of their physical horizons. As in the past, the explorer’s vision
must extend past the physical shoreline. As in the past, the explorer must possess
the internal drive and determination to travel beyond the known limits of society
and science. He or she must travel alone, far from the masses who cling to the firm
security of land.
As in the past, explorers are driven by one thing—the need to discover for
themselves, because accepting anything less than firsthand knowledge is settling
for the beliefs and assumptions of the landlocked.
Today each of us has an opportunity to go beyond the physical shoreline and
become an explorer. This great adventure is available for all of us to share.
Part 1 – Exploring the Mysterious
CHAPTER 1
First Journeys
The most beautiful experience we can have is the mysterious. It is the fundamental
emotion which stands at the cradle of true art and true science. Whoever does not know
it and can no longer wonder, no longer marvel, is as good as dead, and his eyes are
dimmed.
Albert Einstein wrote these words many years ago, and they are forever etched in
my mind. Twenty years ago I firmly believed that the physical world we see and
experience was the only reality. I believed what my eyes told me—life possessed no
hidden mysteries, only countless forms of matter living and dying.
The facts were clear; there was no evidence or proof of nonphysical worlds or our
continued existence after death. I questioned the intelligence of anyone softheaded
enough to accept the illogical concepts of heaven, God, and immortality. In
my mind these were fairy tales created to comfort the weak and manipulate the
masses. For me, life was simple to understand: the world consisted of solid matter
and form, and the concepts of life after death and heaven were feeble human
attempts to create hope where none existed.
I possessed the arrogant knowledge of a man who judges the world with his
physical senses alone. I supported my conclusions with the overwhelming
observations provided by science and technology. After all, if something mysterious
was there, science would certainly be aware of it.
My firm convictions of reality and life continued until June of 1972. During a
conversation with a neighbor, our discussion turned to the possibilities of life after
death and the existence of heaven. I proceeded to present my agnostic viewpoints
with vigor. To my surprise my neighbor didn’t contest my conclusions; instead, he
related an experience that he had had several weeks before. One evening just after
drifting to sleep, he was shocked to discover himself floating above his body.
Completely awake and aware, he became frightened and instantly fell back into his
physical body. Excited, he told me it wasn’t a dream or his imagination, but a fully
conscious experience.
Intrigued by his experience, I decided to investigate this strange phenomenon for
myself. After several days of research I discovered numerous references to out-ofbody
experiences throughout history. With some searching I found a book on the
topic that actually described how out-of-body experiences are induced. The entire
subject seemed extremely weird, and I considered the book the result of an overly
active imagination.
Out of curiosity, I decided to try one of the out-of-body techniques before sleep.
After repeated daily attempts, I began to feel a little ridiculous. In three weeks the
only thing I experienced out of the norm was an increase in my dream recall. I
became more and more convinced that this entire subject was nothing more than
an intense or vivid dream stimulated by the so-called out-of-body techniques.
Then, one night about eleven o’clock I drifted to sleep during my out-of-body
technique and began dreaming that I was sitting at a round table with several
people. They all seemed to be asking me questions related to my self-development
and state of consciousness. At that moment in the dream I began to feel extremely
dizzy, and a strange numbness, like from Novocain, began to spread throughout
my body. Unable to keep my head up, I passed out, hitting my head on the table.
Instantly I was awake, fully conscious, lying in bed facing the wall. I could hear an
unusual buzzing sound and felt somehow different. Extending my arm, I reached
for the wall in front of me. I stared in amazement as my hand actually entered the
wall; I could feel the vibrational energy of it as if I was touching its very molecular
structure. Only then did the overwhelming reality hit me, My God, I’m not in my
body. Excited, my only thought was, It’s real. My God, it’s real! Lying in bed, I
stared at my hand in disbelief.
When I tried clenching my fist, I could feel the pressure of my grip; my hand felt
completely solid, but the physical wall in front of me looked and felt like a dense,
vaporous material with form. Determined to stand, I began to move effortlessly to
the foot of my bed, my mind racing with the reality of it all. Standing, I quickly
touched my arms and legs, checking to see if I was solid, and to my surprise I was
completely solid, completely real. But around me, the familiar physical objects in
my room no longer appeared completely real or solid; instead, they now looked like
three-dimensional mirages. Glancing down, I noticed a large lump in my bed.
Amazed, I could see that it was the sleeping form of my physical body silently
facing the wall.
As I focused my vision on the opposite side of the room, the wall seemed to fade
slowly from view. In front of me I could see a wide, green field extending far
beyond my room. Looking around, I noticed a figure silently watching me from
about ten yards away. It was a tall man with dark hair, a beard, and a purple robe.
Startled by his presence, I became frightened and instantly “snapped back” into my
physical body. With a jolt I was in my body, and a strange feeling of numbness and
tingling faded as I opened my eyes. Excited, I sat up, my mind exploding with the
realization of what had just occurred. I knew it was absolutely real, not a dream or
my imagination. My entire ego awareness had been present.
Suddenly, everything I had ever learned about my existence and the world around
me had to be reappraised. I had always seriously doubted that anything beyond the
physical world existed. Now my entire viewpoint changed. Now I absolutely knew
that other worlds do exist and that people like myself must live there. Most
important, I now knew that my physical body was just a temporary vehicle for the
real me inside, and that with practice I could separate from it at will.
Excited about my discovery, I grabbed a pen and paper and wrote down exactly
what had occurred. A flood of questions filled my mind. Why is the vast majority of
the human race unaware of this phenomenon? Why aren’t the various sciences and
religions investigating it? Is it possible that this unseen world is the “heaven”
referred to in religious texts? Why isn’t our government exploring this apparent
parallel energy world? Is it possible that our overwhelming dependence on physical
perceptions has led us to overlook an incredible avenue of exploration and
discovery?
As the initial shock of my first experience sank in, I realized that my life could
never be the same again. The more I pondered the significance of my experience,
the more profound I realized it to be. All my agnostic beliefs had been swept away
in a single night. I knew that I had to reappraise everything that I had learned
since childhood, everything that I had assumed to be true. My comfortable
conclusions about science, psychology, religion, and my existence had obviously
been based on incomplete information. I felt excited, but also uneasy—my familiar
concepts of reality no longer seemed relevant.
Increasingly, I felt in a void. On several occasions when I talked to friends about
my experience, they found it too bizarre to take seriously. In 1972 the term out-of
body experience had not even been coined; back then, the most common
description was astral projection. No one that I knew at the time had even heard of
astral projection, and if you told people you had left your body, they immediately
thought that you were on drugs or losing your mind. I quickly discovered that I had
to keep my experiences to myself or face some degree of disbelief and even
ridicule.
After my first out-of-body experience, my mind was overflowing with endless
possibilities and questions. Desperate for information and guidance, I spent several
weeks in libraries and bookstores searching for whatever knowledge was available
on the topic. I quickly found that little was available; only a handful of books had
been written on the subject, and some of these were decades old and out of print.
By the end of July 1972, I realized that I was on my own. I decided to focus on the
one technique that had worked for me before. This technique involved visualizing a
physical location that I knew well as I drifted off to sleep. As before, I pictured my
mother’s living room with as much detail as possible. At first it seemed difficult, but
after a few weeks I could picture the room’s details with increasing clarity; the
furniture, patterns in fabrics, textures, even small imperfections in wood and paint
began to be clear in my mind. I realized that the more I pictured myself within the
room interacting with the physical objects, the more detailed my visualizations
would become.
With practice I learned to physically walk around the room and memorize specific
items that it contained. I also learned the importance of “feeling” the environment
with my mind: the feel of carpet on my feet; the sensation of sitting in a chair,
walking, turning on a lamp, or even opening the door. The more detailed and
involved I was within my visualization, the more effective were my results.
Although it was challenging at first, after a while it became fun to make my
visualizations come alive in my mind. At this point I decided to keep a journal to
record my out-of-body experiences.
Journal Entry, August 6, 1972
I awakened at 4:00 A.M. after three and a half hours of sleep and started to read a
book about out-of-body experiences. After reading for about fifteen minutes, I
became sleepy and decided to visualize my mother’s living room. I selected this
because I knew it extremely well. Within the living room are several items I had
made in grade school: a metal ashtray, a wooden doorstop, and a watercolor of the
ocean. As I pictured the room in my mind, I slowly moved my attention to the
items I had made. As vividly as I could, I imagined myself walking around the living
room looking at the furniture and the various things I had made. As I focused on
the items, I began to see the room surprisingly well. I moved my focus from item
to item and visualized myself touching each object. As I became mentally immersed
in the sensations and sights of the living room, I drifted off to sleep.
In seconds I’m shaken awake by intense vibrations and a roaring sound throughout
my body. It feels like I’m in the middle of a jet engine and my body and mind are
about to vibrate apart. I’m shocked and scared by the intensity of the vibrations
and sounds and snap back to my body. As I open my eyes, I realize that I’m
completely numb and that a strange tingling sensation is spreading throughout my
body. Over the next few minutes, my normal physical sensations slowly return. I
can’t believe the intensity of the vibrations. I lie in bed and wonder what these
vibrations and sounds are and what causes them. I know they’re not physical
sensations. I can only guess that they’re somehow connected to my nonphysical
form, possibly my conscious recognition of the transfer of my awareness from my
physical to my nonphysical body.
Maybe I’m simply conscious of a vibrational shift or transition that’s necessary to
have out-of-body experiences. Whatever it is, it can definitely scare the hell out of
you. Even so, I’m determined to find out what’s behind these strange vibrations.
There must be a logical explanation.
For the next week nothing happened. I started to doubt myself and my ability to
have the experience. Then one evening about eleven o’clock I dozed off while
visualizing my mother’s living room. Within minutes I was startled awake by a
piercing buzzing sound and vibrations throughout my body. Opening my eyes, I
realized that I was half in and half out of my body. My first reaction was fear. An
overwhelming panic flooded my mind and I instantly snapped back into my body.
Upon opening my physical eyes, I discovered that my physical body was numb and
tingling; as before, this sensation slowly dissipated and my normal physical feelings
returned. I sat up in bed shocked by the intensity of the vibrations and sounds. I
clearly remember saying aloud, “What the hell was that?” As I reviewed the
experience I realized that I was completely unprepared. An instinctual fear seemed
to flow through me at the first hints of separation.
For two nights nothing unusual occurred. Then on the third night I awakened to a
weird numbness and vibration spreading from the back of my neck to the rest of
my body. I tried my best to stay calm and reduce my fear, but I couldn’t, I felt as
though I was completely out of control and vulnerable. Startled, I spontaneously
thought about my physical body and the vibrations slowly subsided. As my physical
sensations returned, I felt disappointed that I’d missed a great opportunity to
explore. In an effort to save the moment, I calmed down, focused my thoughts
away from my physical body, and began to encourage the vibrations to return. (I
did this by concentrating on the vibrational sensations I had just experienced at
the back of my neck.)
After about fifteen minutes, as I gradually relaxed and again drifted between sleep
and wakefulness, the vibrations began to return. They started at the back of my
neck, then slowly spread to my whole body until I was vibrating at what felt like a
higher frequency or energy level. This time I remained calm, my anxiety level
decreasing as I recognized that the vibrational sensations were somewhat
enjoyable when I was prepared. A high-pitched buzzing seemed to resonate in my
body, and I felt energized and light as a feather. With a thought of floating I could
feel myself moving upward. I was completely weightless, and for the first time the
sensations were absolutely wonderful. I floated up to the ceiling and touched it with
my hand. Amazed, I realized that I was touching the energy substance of the
ceiling. Pressing my hand into the hazy molecular structure, I felt the tingling
vibrational energy of the ceiling. As I withdrew my hand from the ceiling, I noticed
that my arm sparkled like a thousand points of brilliant blue and white lights. Out of
curiosity, I reached out my other hand and grasped my outstretched arm, and to
my surprise it was solid to the touch. Focusing on my arm, I became mesmerized
by the depth and beauty of the lights. I realized that my arm appeared to be a
universe of stars. It’s strange to describe, but I felt drawn into a universe that was
me. At that instant I snapped back into my body, and the numbness and tingling
sensations quickly subsided as I opened my eyes in awe.
Journal Entry, October 4, 1972
I silently repeat an affirmation, “Now I’m out-of-body,” for ten to fifteen minutes as
I grow increasingly sleepy. As much as possible, I intensify my affirmations as I
drift off to sleep. Almost instantly I’m awakened by intense vibrations and an
electrical-like buzzing throughout my body. I’m startled, and an intense wave of
fear surges through me. I calm myself down by repeating, “I’m protected by the
light.” My initial fear slowly dissipates as I visualize myself surrounded by a globe of
protective light. I think of floating and feel myself lift up and out of my physical
body. I feel light as a feather and float slowly upward. As I float away from my
body I realize that the vibrations and buzzing have diminished to a slight humming
sensation. Feeling more secure, I open my eyes and find myself staring at the
ceiling two feet in front of me. I’m surprised that I’ve floated that high and
instinctively think about looking at my body on the bed. Instantly, I snap back to
my physical body and feel a strange vibration as my physical sensations quickly
return.
As I lie in bed reviewing the experience, I realize that my thoughts directed toward
my physical body must have snapped me back. I know it’s possible to view my
physical body, because during my first out-of- body experience I distinctly saw it. I
suspect the key to observing our physical bodies is to remain as mentally and
emotionally detached as possible, but more important, we must keep our thoughts
directed away from our physical bodies; the slightest thought focused on the body
will immediately snap us back to it. In retrospect, I should have thought about
turning over as I floated; then I could have observed my physical body without any
thoughts being focused on it.
Journal Entry, October 12, 1972
I wake up at 3:15 after three and a half hours of sleep (two REM periods) and
move to the sofa in the living room. After about forty minutes of reading, I become
sleepy and begin to do a different visualization. I picture myself as a bright orange
balloon filling with helium. I can feel myself becoming lighter and lighter as the
balloon expands. I intensify and hold my visualization as long as possible.
Drifting off to sleep I awaken to the sensation of intense vibrations and buzzing
throughout my body. I recognize that I’m ready to separate and immediately think
about floating. The vibrations and sounds rapidly diminish as I separate and float
up to the ceiling. Out of instinct I reach out my arms to touch the ceiling, but
instead of touching, my hands slowly enter the tingling vibrational substance of the
ceiling. I can feel a slight resistance as my hands and arms move through the
ceiling. Moving slowly upward, my body enters and passes through the insulation,
rafters, and attic. An intense excitement flows through me as I pass through the
roof and float at the top of the house.
I think of standing and I’m instantly upright, standing at the highest peak of the
house. As I look around, I can clearly see the TV antenna and chimney. Even
though it’s the middle of the night, the sky and everything around me are partially
lighted by a luminescent silvery glow.
Standing at the top of the house, I have a sudden urge to fly. I spread my arms,
glide down from the roof, and fly over my backyard. I slowly descend until I’m
flying about four feet above the ground. For some reason I feel as if I’m getting
heavier and continue descending until I’m just inches above the grass. I think
“control” but it’s too late. With a thud I crash face first onto the lawn. At that
instant I’m back in my physical body. My physical sensations return and I wonder
why I lost control. Why did I become so heavy?
Journal Entry, November 2, 1972
I awaken to the sound and sensations of intense buzzing. It feels as if my body and
mind are vibrating apart. At first I’m startled by the intensity of the vibrations, but
slowly I calm myself and focus my full attention on the idea of floating away from
my physical body. In seconds I float up and out of my body and hover several feet
above it. I notice that the buzzing noise and vibrations immediately subside after
complete separation. The sound and vibrations are replaced by a serene feeling of
calm. It feels as if I’m weightless and floating like a cloud. I think of moving to the
door and I seem to automatically float to that destination. I feel an overwhelming
sense of freedom I’ve never known before. Spontaneously I decide to fly and think
about flying through the roof. Instantly I fly straight up through the ceiling and
pass through the roof like a rocket. I’m thrilled by the response and begin to understand
that my thoughts are the energy of my personal propulsion. I spread my
arms and level off several hundred feet in the air. Below me I can clearly see the
buildings and roads of my neighborhood. I feel a slight tugging sensation as I fly
higher and higher over the city of Baltimore. The tugging sensation increases and I
think of my body. Instantly, I snap back to my body. My physical body is numb and
tingling as I open my eyes.
As my out-of-body experiences continued, I became fascinated with the nonphysical
energy structures I observed. With each experience my questions seemed to
grow until I became obsessed with trying to understand the nature of the nonphysical
forms that I had encountered. In an attempt to comprehend the relationship
between the physical and nonphysical environments, I developed a series of crude
experiments. For example, every day I would balance a pencil or pen at the very
edge of my nightstand. My purpose was to see if I could somehow move the physical
object with my nonphysical body. I quickly discovered that this simple experiment
was more difficult than it appeared. My biggest obstacle was attempting to
focus on my experiment. At the moment of separation my mind would race with
unlimited possibilities, and my experiment seemed insignificant compared with the
many wonders that were available.
Each experience increased my realization that my nonphysical state of consciousness
was extremely sensitive and responsive to the slightest thought. My prevailing
conscious and subconscious thoughts would instantly propel me in a specific
direction. I quickly learned that my subconscious mind exerts much more influence
and control over my actions than I ever imagined. Often, a completely spontaneous
thought would create an immediate reaction. For example, if I thought about flying,
which I often did, I would immediately fly through the ceiling or wall and glide over
my neighborhood.
Gradually, I realized that gaining full conscious control during the first seconds after
separation was absolutely essential. To accomplish this I experimented with
different ways to gain control. At first I tried focusing my full attention on my hand
or arm just after separation. I hoped that this would concentrate my thoughts on a
single idea and give me the immediate control that I was seeking. This created a
strange sensation of being immersed within myself. Though exhilarating, the end
result was not control but a feeling of being mesmerized and then drawn into a
sparkling universe of brilliant blue stars. Unhappy with the results, I decided to try
grabbing my non-physical arm and focusing on the sensations of my grip. I was
somewhat surprised to discover that the feel of my nonphysical arm was amazingly
solid. My nonphysical body possessed an inherent vibrational quality; it felt
completely solid, but I could feel the mild vibrational energy of my arm’s substance.
I quickly discovered that my energy-body was indeed “real” in every respect,
appearing to be an exact duplicate of my physical body. I also found that when my
thoughts were focused on my nonphysical body I began to feel myself drawn
inward, as if I were being pulled into a vacuum deep inside myself.
Over a period of several months I repeated this procedure of self-examination, and
through trial and error I learned about my nonphysical body. With repeated
observations I began to realize that my nonphysical form was like an energy mold—
in effect, conscious energy that had assumed a temporary form. The body I
experienced when out-of-body appeared to be the result of my mind’s expectations
and self-concept. In addition, I recognized that focusing on my nonphysical body
created a strong tendency for me to be drawn inward to areas I could not begin to
comprehend. I knew that I needed another method for gaining conscious control.
After almost a year I was becoming frustrated by numerous failed attempts to gain
full control when I finally discovered that I was making this entire process more
involved than it needed to be. During an afternoon out-of-body experience, I
spontaneously shouted, “Control now!” Immediately I felt an enhancement of my
analytical mind. As I stood by the foot of my bed, my vision improved but remained
slightly out-of-focus, so I shouted, “Clarity now!” My vision instantly snapped into
focus. I felt a rush of energy and awareness flow through my body and mind. I was
thrilled. For the first time I felt in complete control: my entire self-awareness was
present, and I actually felt more aware than in my normal physical state of
consciousness. My thoughts were crystal clear and vibrantly alive. I suddenly
realized that the key to control was simply to demand full conscious control
immediately after separation. I also began to understand the importance of
focusing my thoughts and the need to be extremely specific when making requests.
On one occasion, just after separation, I said aloud, “I request full waking
consciousness,” and instantly snapped back into my physical body. I found that the
controlling portion of my mind takes my thoughts literally. My poor choice of the
word waking was immediately interpreted to mean physical waking. After several
months of experimenting with different phrases, I began to recognize that I had
unintentionally programmed myself to think “control” during each out-of-body
experience. I soon discovered myself doing it automatically as I floated up and
away from my body. After a year of trial and error, I knew I was finally on the right
track.
Throughout this period I continued my pencil experiments. During several out-ofbody
experiences, I tried to move the pencil balanced on the nightstand and was
surprised to find that the vibrational frequency (density) of my nonphysical body
seemed to determine whether the pencil or even the entire room was visible to me.
Slowly I came to understand that the environment I was observing was not the
physical world, as I had assumed. I realized that the structures I normally observed
when out-of-body were nonphysical structures. Gradually, it all started to fit
together. Now I finally understood why there were slight variations between the
nonphysical and physical furniture and other objects. For example, the nonphysical
walls were often a different color, and the shapes and styles of some of the
furniture and rugs were different. Much of this was minor but nevertheless
noticeable.
For me to be able to see my normal physical surroundings, my internal vibrational
rate had to be relatively dense, or slow. I also noticed that the very act of
requesting consciousness and clarity seemed to automatically increase the internal
frequency of my nonphysical body. In an effort to make my experiments more
realistic, I balanced pencils at three different areas that I normally passed upon
leaving my body. My hope was that I would notice the pencils, at the side of bed or
at the foot of the bed, as I moved past them. Looking back, I realize that it
probably looked a little strange. On one occasion I remember my mother asking
me, “What’s with the pencils?” Just imagine trying to explain this to your mother
without sounding like a nut.
After several weeks, I finally focused on one of the pencils after separation. As I
moved to the side of bed, I concentrated on the pencil at the edge of my dresser.
At first my vision seemed foggy, somehow out of sync, so I said aloud, “Clarity
now!” Instantly my vision snapped in focus. I could clearly see the pencil in front of
me; however, it appeared like a three-dimensional hazy form with substance. I
moved closer, touched it with my hand, and felt a slight vibrational sensation as my
fingers passed through the substance of the pencil. Somewhat frustrated, I tried
again but experienced the same results. Focusing my attention, I realized that my
nonphysical body was obviously less dense than the pencil, and spontaneously said
aloud, “I need to be denser.” With a jolt I shot back into my physical body. As my
physical sensations returned, I couldn’t help but laugh: I had received my request.
I had to remember that requests made when out-of-body are taken literally. There
seems to be little room for interpretation or shades of gray. I would have to
remember to be extremely specific with each request. Maybe something like “I wish
to move this pencil” would have been more effective.
In a related experience some years later, I was practicing self-hypnosis with a
single lighted candle. After separation I stood by the candle and decided to blow it
out. To my surprise it went out immediately. Upon returning to my physical body, I
opened my eyes to find that the physical candle was still burning. After some
thought I realized that I must have blown out a candle in what I now know is the
parallel dimension closest to the physical. This dimension is a relatively dense
energy duplicate of the physical world. This simple experiment is important because
it provides evidence that the environments and objects encountered during out-ofbody
experiences exist independently of the physical universe. It appears that we
are not observing the physical world from a different perspective, as many believe,
but are interacting in a separate but parallel dimension of energy.
Journal Entry, June 21, 1973
I wake up at 5:00 A.M. and move to the sofa. After reading for about fifteen
minutes I become sleepy and decide to try something new. I grab a sheet of paper
and begin to write out-of-body affirmations. “Now I’m out-of-body.” As I write, I
verbally repeat them to myself. After writing fifty or so I can barely keep my eyes
open. As I drift to sleep, I continue the affirmations in my mind. I’m startled awake
by a strange numbness and vibrations throughout my body. I stay as calm as
possible and focus on the sensations of floating upward. After several seconds, I
feel myself lift up and out of my body. I stand beside my body and walk to the
window. I feel somehow out of focus and request clarity.
There’s only a small improvement so I repeat my request, and this time I’m more
demanding: “I need clarity now!” Instantly, my awareness becomes crystal clear.
My body feels lighter and more energized. I feel vibrantly awake and aware and
decide to try to fly. Stretching out my arms, I take a small leap and fly through the
ceiling and roof, until I’m several hundred feet above my neighborhood. I rotate my
arms slightly and level off. It’s absolutely exhilarating. I feel completely free as I
glide over the town of Catonsville. Even though it’s night, the landscape is
illuminated by a silvery glow. Below me the houses and streets appear like a
Christmas garden. Suddenly, I feel a tugging sensation at my back and
spontaneously think of my body. The thought of my body snaps me back to it with
a jolt. I awaken with a slight numbness and tingling throughout my body.
Journal Entry, July 3, 1973
I awaken to the sound and sensation of intense buzzing. It feels as if my body and
mind are inside an engine. At first I’m startled by the intensity of the vibrations, but
slowly I calm myself and direct my full attention to the idea of floating from my
body. Immediately I separate and float upward to the ceiling.
After separation I notice that the loud, roaring noise has faded. As I float about four
feet above my body, the vibrations are replaced by a feeling of calm. It feels as if
I’m weightless and floating like a cloud. With a single thought of moving to the
door, I seem to be automatically propelled to that destination.
Focusing my thought, I think of the living room and float directly there. I can’t
believe how easy and natural it is. I think of standing and I’m standing in the living
room examining my surroundings. Everything around me looks familiar, except that
the walls are now light yellow instead of white and some of the furniture is slightly
different from its physical counterpart. For example, an antique lion-head rocking
chair looks the same but the coffee table looks different. The physical table is a
modern style, while its nonphysical counterpart looks like an eighteenth-century
antique.
As I stare at my surroundings I realize that I can see through the hazy outline of
the physical walls. When I focus on the living room wall, it appears to become
increasingly vaporous in its form and substance and slowly disappears. In front of
me is an entirely new environment, a sprawling meadow extending as far as I can
see. I step forward several steps and enter the new terrain. As I look out into the
meadow I notice the figure of a man standing about twenty yards away. He’s
watching me intently but does not approach. For several moments I stare in his
direction. He has dark hair and a close-cropped beard and wears a purple robe that
extends to his knees. He acknowledges my stare by nodding his head and flashing
a small smile.
The entire situation is overwhelming. I feel uneasy and unsure of what to do next.
Should I walk over and communicate with this stranger or avoid him? My dilemma
is quickly resolved when I snap back into my physical body.
As I lie in bed it hits me that this man might be the same person I saw during my
first out-of-body experience. The more I review his appearance, the more
convinced I am that this man is not just a nonphysical resident “passing by”; he
seems to be watching my every move. It is also apparent that he had no intention
of approaching or communicating with me. I suspect that he knew that any
movement on his part toward me would probably have scared me; just the sight of
someone standing there was unsettling enough.
For several days, curiosity concerning this man fills my mind. What are his
intentions and purpose? I wonder if he is some sort of guide observing my
progress. In addition, I wonder if everyone having out-of-body experiences has
someone observing their progress. He obviously did not wish to interfere; in fact,
he seemed almost surprised when I finally did see him. I can only speculate that he
probably was observing my out-of-body experiences from a slightly different
vibrational level in order to remain unobserved. When I focused my attention I
must have raised my vibrational rate and was then able to see beyond my normal
physical-like surroundings.
Comparing this to my first experience, I realize that they were similar in many
respects. The main difference was that my control and vision were better this time.
The more I thought about my experiences, the more I realized that everything I
believed to be fact or truth had to be reappraised. For example, the long-standing
“fact” that our consciousness is the result of electrochemical activity within the
brain was now a laughable conclusion resulting from obviously incomplete
information. Now I knew that the brain had to serve some other function, possibly
as a biological transfer device between the nonphysical mind and the physical body.
It became clear that the physical brain is similar to a computer’s hard drive, storing
information and memories needed to support and operate our temporary biological
vehicle.
As my out-of-body experiences continued, this observation was confirmed time and
again. One thing was certain, I could think without my physical brain; I could
create, analyze, and recall thoughts. I also recognized that there were definite
differences. For example, when out-of-body I was more spontaneous and singleminded
than in my physical body. I felt somehow motivated to do things I wouldn’t
ever consider while in my body. For example, I would often think about flying and
then instantly fly out of the room and glide around my neighborhood, or find myself
flying over strange landscapes I couldn’t begin to identify. I sometimes suspected
that I was being directed by a more expansive, unknown part of myself. Often my
spontaneous thoughts would lead me to situations and experiences that provided
insight into areas or events that were related to my past or present. On numerous
occasions I didn’t understand the reason for these experiences until weeks or even
years later.
The next experience had a profound effect on me. For the first time I truly realized
the unlimited potential of nonphysical explorations.
Journal Entry, July 9, 1973
Around noon I decide to take a nap. I visualize my mother’s living room as I drift
off to sleep. A sensation of numbness and tingling energy spreads throughout my
body. I enjoy the sensation and easily lift out of my body. A feeling of excitement
flows through me as I move to the foot of the bed. As I look around, I have a
sudden urge to see the young woman in the apartment above mine. Instantly I
float upward and feel my head and shoulders enter the ceiling. For some unknown
reason I encounter an intense resistance and can’t pass through the ceiling. For a
moment I’m stuck in the ceiling and I begin to panic. I say aloud, “Down,” and
instantly move down to the floor. With a feeling of relief I calm down and center
myself. I walk to my bedroom door and step into it. As I move through the door I
feel a slight tingling sensation but encounter no problems; up close the door has a
misty, hazy appearance. Walking normally, I enter the living room and am heading
toward the front door when suddenly, to my right, I clearly hear a man’s voice
calling my name: “Willie.”
Startled, I look around and stare at a man sitting on the sofa. He appears to be in
his late twenties and somehow seems familiar.
“Willie, it’s good to see you.”
I recognize his voice and immediately know that it’s my uncle Hilton in front of me.
Shocked by his presence, I just stare at him as he speaks.
“I bet you’re surprised to see me.”
He chuckles as he continues. “Had a little trouble with the ceiling.”
I step closer and ask, “Uncle Hilton, is that you?”
He smiles again. “Yes, it’s me.”
I look at him closely. He appears twenty years younger and much thinner than
when he died.
He seems amused by my stare and says, “Hey, I’m just as surprised to see you as
you are to see me.
His tone becomes more serious. “Willie, how did you learn to do this?”
I’m surprised by his question and respond, “I just tried it and it worked.”
“There aren’t many who can do what you do. All of us are quite surprised.” He
gazes at me, waiting for my reply.
As I look at him, the reality of the situation is overwhelming. For some reason I feel
a sudden inner need to fly.
“Uncle Hilton, I have to go.
He smiles and nods as I move to the door.
I easily step through the front door and see a broad green field before me. (My
physical surroundings are an apartment complex.) I step outside and extend my
arms above me. My impulse to fly seems to propel me into the air like a rocket. I
spread my arms, level off, and experiment with controlling my flight. As I look
around, I can clearly see Route 40 below me. I decide to follow the road and fly
west several hundred feet above the ground. Intense exhilaration and freedom
radiate from every part of my being.
Looking down, I can clearly see the road, homes, and even entire subdivisions. As I
pass over Ellicort City, I feel a tugging sensation at the center of my back and think
of my body. In a flash I snap back in my physical body and can feel a slight tingling
and numbness that quickly dissipate.
As soon as my physical senses return, I find my mother’s old photo albums and
search for a picture of my dead uncle. Turning the pages wildly, I finally locate a
photograph of him as a young man in his twenties. Without a doubt the thirty-yearold
photograph before me is the exact image of the man I just met.
As I review this experience, a couple of things become clear. First, we obviously
continue after death. Even though I have known this since my first out-of-body
experience, it becomes even more apparent when you actually see and speak with
a deceased person you have known. There is simply no way I could be mistaken;
the man with whom I just had a conversation was definitely my uncle. Second, it
strikes me that my uncle appeared to be in the prime of life—I would guess late
twenties. In fact, he was so young I couldn’t immediately (at least visually)
recognize him. It was his distinctive voice and his calling me “Willie” that really
made it clear who he was. My deceased uncle is the only person who ever called
me Willie; everyone else called me William or Bill.
When my uncle died, he was fifty-four years old and considerably overweight; yet
when I saw him, he appeared young, thin, and vibrantly healthy. It seems likely
that after we shed our physical body at death, we assume the energy form molded
or influenced by our concept of ourselves. Since I’ve learned that nonphysical
energies are naturally thought-responsive, it seems reasonable that our thoughts
and self-image would influence our personal energy. It appears likely that we may
assume the nonphysical form that most fits our self-conception.
If this is the case, I can’t help but wonder what I look like when I leave my body.
Do I look the same as my physical body? I also wonder if my form would change if
I intentionally altered my self-image. It sounds kind of bizarre, but it seems
possible that our nonphysical shape and form may also be a temporary vehicle, just
like the physical body. I seriously wonder what would happen if (when out-ofbody),
I concentrated on changing the shape and form of my nonphysical body.
For several weeks, the meeting with my deceased uncle filled my mind. I was sure
that he had seemed surprised and curious about my ability to leave my body, yet I
also knew that he had appeared to be waiting for me—he seemed to know that I
would walk into the living room. Maybe that was the reason I couldn’t go through
the ceiling when I tried. It’s possible that I was being somehow directed to the
living room. In addition, I had a strange sense that someone had been sitting next
to him. It’s hard to explain, but I had felt someone else there, and I was sure that
for a brief moment I had seen the subtle outline of a woman.
I continued to follow the pattern that had worked for me in the past. I would wake
up at seven o’clock and get ready for a college class at nine o’clock. After my class
I would come back to my mother’s apartment and read until I became sleepy.
Generally about noon I would begin to do my out-of-body technique. I continued to
experiment with different methods but found that the simplest one worked best. I
would go to my room, lie in bed, and visualize myself walking around the living
room examining all the small details associated with the room. Often I would pick
out three or four objects in the room and do my best to picture them clearly in my
mind. I didn’t understand or even think about the mechanics of what I was doing; I
only knew that it worked.
An estimated 30 percent of the time, after dozing off I would find myself sitting up,
floating, or rolling sideways out of my body. The sensations during separation were
normally similar: a buzzing sound accompanied by an internal high-energy or
vibrational feeling spreading through my body. At the peak of the vibrations I would
mentally direct myself away from my body by sitting up or rolling out of my body. I
preferred sitting up because rolling out would often cause a disjointed or
disoriented feeling. I discovered that the easiest way was simply to sit up and step
away from my body. I seemed to maintain more conscious control over my
nonphysical energy-body this way. It’s possible that the physical-like movements
associated with walking had a grounding effect.
Journal Entry, September 14, 1973
As I become sleepy, I mentally repeat my regular affirmation, “Now I’m out of
body.” At the same time I visualize objects in my mother’s living room. After about
fifteen minutes, I drift off. Suddenly, I’m startled awake by the sound of a gunshot
near my head. My body is completely numb and an overwhelming flood of energy is
flowing through me. I’m scared and instinctively think of my physical body. With a
jolt I’m back in my body, looking around the room for the source of the sound.
After my physical sensations return, I realize that I’ve handled this experience
poorly. I suspect that the gunshot was an internal sound, probably caused by the
act of separating from my physical body, and that I may have separated from a
connecting point located somewhere in my head.
There is a theory that all of us are connected to our physical bodies at seven
energy locations and that a loud popping sound may indicate a separation occurring
at or near the pineal gland. Currently I have no evidence to support this theory, but
I must admit that my experience is remarkably similar to sounds reported by
Sylvan Muldoon and Paul Twitchell. Little research exists on the sensations and
sounds associated with out-of-body experiences. I hope that in the near future this
will change. When we consider the vast potential for knowledge available, it’s only
reasonable that more research should be conducted. I firmly believe that additional
research would uncover new insights into the unseen nature and source of
consciousness.
Journal Entry, October 25, 1973
I become increasingly relaxed and drowsy as I repeat an out-of-body affirmation,
“Now I’m out-of-body.” The next thing I know, I’m sitting up in bed completely
aware and looking around my room. Vibrations flow through me as I lift and
separate from my body, walk through my bedroom wall, and enter a new
environment. I am walking on a sidewalk or path of some kind, and all around me
is a wide, flat expanse. In the distance a radio tower extends as far as I can see. I
have a strong urge to go to it and say to myself, “I must make it to the tower.”
Instantly I am closer to it. Directly in front of me are dozens of old metal trash cans
blocking my way. I begin to push them aside and ask aloud, “What do these things
represent?” At that instant, a series of vivid pictures appears in my mind; I can’t
tell if it’s originating from within me or somehow outside of me. “Very good, you’re
starting to understand. You are in a higher vibratory region, a thought-responsive
environment. Your perceptions of your surroundings are created by your mind. Your
mind is interpreting the environment according to the reference points and forms it
can relate to."
My mind overflows with excitement. For the first rime, I understand the obvious.
The sidewalk is my path, the direction of my life. The trash cans are all the garbage
that slows my progress: my fears, limits, and attachments. All these things must be
removed from my path for me to move forward and achieve my spiritual goals. I
stare at the trash cans for a moment; they appear old and battered. With a feeling
of intense joy and satisfaction I toss the trash cans out of my way. A surge of
energy flows through me as I clear my path of the obstacles. I feel empowered and
filled with energy as I step toward the radio tower and discover that I’m directly
beside it. I look for the entrance but can’t find one anywhere. As I walk around the
perimeter, I suddenly feel an intense tugging sensation. I know I have to return to
my body.
With a single thought of my physical body I’m instantly within it. I open my eyes
and realize that my bladder is full. I’m a little upset with myself for not planning
better. Now I’m really curious about the radio tower and exactly what it
represented. Why couldn’t I find the door? I have an idea but I need confirmation.
More important, I wonder about the communication I received. It’s difficult to
explain, but it was very clear in my mind; it seemed more like pictures than words.
Even more important, I realize that this experience is different from all previous
ones. I entered a completely different environment, a nonphysical world that
appeared separate from the physical-like surroundings that I normally experience.
In addition, the surroundings seemed to respond easily to my thoughts. I felt
somehow different, lighter, more energized. I don’t really understand, but I suspect
that this is important.
Journal Entry, November 12, 1973
I feel a slight vibration and a sense of rapid motion. I’m suddenly in an ornate
cathedral, standing in front of a tall pulpit. I feel completely comfortable and
quickly climb the steps to the pulpit. I’m prepared to address the crowd, but as I
look down I realize that no one is present. Confused and unsure of what to do next,
I snap back into my body and find myself sitting up in bed fully awake and aware.
Surprised, I think to myself, That’s strange; I’ve never had an out-of-body
experience while sitting up. Then it hits me—I’m not in my physical body at all. I
look around and see that my physical body is lying in the bed, sound asleep. A
wave of excitement surges through me as I realize that the cathedral experience
occurred in a completely different energy-body. For the first time it becomes clear:
the “feel” of the two nonphysical bodies are dramatically different. The energy-body
I’m in now is much denser, almost physical when compared with the lightness of
the second energy-body.
With that experience, I realized that the first (dense) nonphysical body is actually
an energy duplicate of the physical, while the second possesses a finer vibratory
rate, like pure energy, ready to respond to the slightest thought. The more I
thought about my realization, the more excited I became. I knew I had made
a major breakthrough because now I understood how limited the first energy-body
really is. This also explained why my abilities and perceptions varied so much when
out-of-body. In theory, I should be able to consciously move from one energy form
to the next. In a sense, I should be able to jettison the first body and move to the
second at will. I couldn’t wait to have my next experience and test out my theory.
For a week I tried without success; then finally it happened. After sleeping for five
hours, I awoke at 6:00 A.M. and moved to the sofa. After about fifteen minutes of
reading, I became drowsy and repeated my favorite affirmation, “Now I’m out-ofbody,”
forty to fifty times as I drifted off to sleep. I immediately recognized the
vibrational state, lifted out of my physical body, and took several steps to the door.
Instead of walking through the door as I normally would, I requested clarity and
firmly asked to experience my second energy form: “I move to my higher body.” I
felt a surge of energy and was instantly in a completely new environment. I was
absolutely thrilled; it had worked. I felt energized and light as a feather; my mind
came alive with possibilities. Out of habit I asked for clarity and my mind became
crystal clear. For the first time I truly understood what being conscious meant. My
thoughts became faster, more vibrant and alive than ever before. It’s difficult to
describe, but I felt incredibly expansive, without fears or limits. I realized that the
physical state of consciousness is a dull perception, like a hazy dream. In addition,
I recognized that the first nonphysical body is very similar to the physical.
Looking back at this experience, I remembered a gradual change of my nonphysical
body as I moved inward. It became clear that as I increased my personal energy
frequency, I automatically moved inward within the interior, nonphysical regions of
the universe. This discovery has significance for all of us. Not only our frequency
and density but also our nonphysical shape and form change as we explore inward.
After experiencing this change on a number of occasions, I could no longer ignore
the importance of the discovery. Our bodies’ personal energy frequency is directly
related to the frequency of our immediate surroundings. As a result, when we alter
our personal energy frequency we automatically move to the nonphysical energy
level of the universe that corresponds to our own internal frequency. Once I gained
some degree of self-control over my nonphysical explorations, I began to
experiment with consciously altering my personal frequency rate. I discovered that
this can be achieved by simply requesting an energy change when out-of-body.
For two years I had believed that I was moving laterally from one area to another
within the same dimension, but now the startling truth was apparent. I was not
moving laterally but inwardly within the universe from one energy environment to
another. Lateral motion felt different; it was generally more physical-like in its
sensations. After repeated trial and error, I arrived at a series of observations.
First, when we request a change in our nonphysical energy-body, it will
immediately respond to our focused request or demand. Second, when we make a
request to raise our vibratory rate or move inward, our consciousness automatically
propels us into a higher-frequency area of the universe. And third, our internal
frequency always corresponds to the frequency rate of the new dimension or
environment that we are experiencing. With practice it’s possible to consciously
alter and control the personal vibrational frequency of our nonphysical body. This
process is the key to true control and unlimited freedom when out-of-body. With
this knowledge it’s possible to move from one energy dimension to another with full
conscious control, but more important, it gives us the ability to explore the entire
multidimensional universe. This inner motion, when controlled, provides us with the
capability to become fully conscious inter-dimensional beings. The following is an
example.
Journal Entry, March 12, 1974
I repeat my regular affirmations at noon, “Now I’m out-of-body,” and slowly drift
off. Within seconds I feel the vibrational state, will myself away from my sleeping
physical body, and move to the foot of the bed. I immediately demand “Clarity
now!” and my vision improves. Feeling centered, I stand at the foot of my bed and
say aloud, “I move inward.” I feel an immediate sensation of rapid inner motion—
I’m being drawn into a vacuum deep within myself. The sensation of motion is so
intense that I shout “Stop!” Instantly I stop moving and realize that I’m in a new
environment. I am outdoors in a beautiful park-like setting. My vision is hazy so I
repeat my clarity demand, “Clarity now!” My vision and thoughts seem to snap into
place. My body feels lighter and vibrantly energetic. I attempt to stay calm as my
thoughts race.
I look down and feel my body. I have a distinctive shape and form much like my
normal nonphysical body; however, this form somehow feels lighter and more
energized than my first energy-body. Excited with my success, I say aloud, “I move
to the next level.” Instantly I’m drawn inward at incredible speed. I can barely hold
on and my fear begins to build. Within seconds the inner motion abruptly stops and
I’m floating in another strange environment. This time few objects are visible, but I
feel intense energy radiating around me. As I look around, I realize that I don’t
need to turn my head; I seem to see wherever I direct my thoughts, and I can see
in every direction simultaneously. I look down at my body but see nothing that I
can describe; I’m a 360-degree viewpoint without form or substance. I feel an
overpowering sense of energy and knowledge flowing through me. My entire being
is immersed in a sea of pure energy and unconditional love.
For what feels like hours I enjoy the soothing sensations of floating in this ocean of
pure living light. Not wishing to return to my physical body, I hold my focus as long
as possible. Finally I return to my body and look at the clock. I’m surprised—I was
gone for less than forty minutes.
As I reviewed my experiences I tried to arrive at a clearer understanding of my
nonphysical existence. Certain similarities and differences between my physical and
nonphysical body were now apparent. For example, I realized that my sight when
out-of-body was very similar to the physical. The only noticeable difference was in
its clarity. My vision just after separation was often blurry and out of sync. I could
quickly improve it, however, by demanding “Clarity now.” I found it essential to do
this during each out-of-body experience and often repeated my request several
times during a single out-of-body experience. I noticed that I relied heavily on my
sense of sight. The other senses seemed almost unimportant in comparison. In
retrospect, I believe this may owe to my current physical dependence on vision.
Each of us is different; some of us may focus more on hearing or touch than on
vision. I suspect that each of us would probably lean upon one sense more heavily
than the others. For example, a professional musician might focus on hearing and a
dancer might tend to focus on touch.
I also recognized that breathing was no longer necessary and that the sensations of
temperature appeared nonexistent. Even though I experienced no sensation of
temperature, I did have a sense of touch and could feel objects and even feel my
grip. In addition, while my sense of hearing remained much the same, my sense of
taste appeared to be absent. Later I was to discover that all five senses are
available if we focus upon them.
With experience I came to understand that all of our nonphysical senses are
created and controlled by our minds. I seriously question whether our nonphysical
bodies contain any natural or inherent ability to perceive at all. Our thoughts mold
the nonphysical body in accordance to our current self-image. I grew to understand
that my physical body was only a temporary vehicle for expression. In time I came
to realize that this also applies to our nonphysical bodies. I recognized that my
nonphysical form was in many ways an energy duplicate of my physical body. My
overall size and shape remained the same; however, the energy substances I was
made of were quite different. Instead of molecules, my nonphysical body appeared
to be made of countless tiny points of interconnected light. On two occasions I tried
to look into a mirror (a physical mirror) when out-of-body but could see nothing.
My curiosity about the appearance, construction, and substance of my nonphysical
body increased with each out-of-body adventure. Even though I could easily
observe my hand and arm when out-of-body, seeing my entire form proved to be a
challenge. Finally, after ten years of out-of-body experiences, the following
occurred.
Journal Entry, October 2, 1982
I hear the buzzing, engine-like sounds and will myself out-of-body. I step to the
bedroom door and automatically request “Clarity now!” My vision improves and I
step through the door, into the living room. Still feeling a little out of sync, I
verbally repeat my request with more emphasis, “Clarity now!” I feel my awareness
and vision snap into place. My thoughts are clear and I make a verbal demand, “I
need to see the form I’m in now!” Instantly I feel an intense sensation of being
drawn within myself. I’m suddenly different, weightless as though I’m floating in
space. As I look forward I see a sparkling, bluish white form. For some reason, I
seem to know that I’m looking at my nonphysical body from a different perspective.
I stare in amazement at this form before me that shines and flows with energy and
light. It looks like an energy mold created from a million tiny points of light; it
radiates a bluish glow but appears to have a defined outer structure. The body of
light before me is naked and is identical to my physical form. Even though my body
looks firm, there is a noticeable energy motion and radiation present. I can see
what appears to be an ocean of blue stars throughout my body. It’s difficult to
describe because the stars are stable, yet moving at the same time; the light and
energy of my body appear to change and flow almost like the waves of an ocean.
As I stare at the body of light, it hits me that I must be in another body. Yet I can’t
perceive any form or substance; I’m like a viewpoint in space without shape or
form of any kind. As I reflect upon my new state of being, I feel a sensation of
rapid motion and I’m instantly back within my physical body.
Lying still and reviewing my experience, I’m struck by an inescapable conclusion: I
must possess multiple energy-bodies. The form I just experienced was noticeably
lighter (less dense) than even my second nonphysical body. I realize that the
traditional view of our possessing two bodies—a physical body and a spiritual
body—is far too simplistic; we are much more complex than this. Just as there are
multiple nonphysical energy dimensions within the universe, each of us must
consist of multiple energybodies or vehicles of expression. Now I seriously wonder
just how many nonphysical bodies or forms this involves. I suspect that there must
be one within each dimension of the universe and that all of these are interrelated
and connected, just as the physical body is connected to its first nonphysical
(spiritual) body.
Journal Entry, October 17, 1983
I feel a strange vibration and tingling throughout my body. Recognizing that I must
be in the vibrational state, I focus all my attention on the sensation of floating out
of my physical body. Within seconds I float up and away from my body and slowly
glide feet first toward the bedroom door. With a sense of absolute amazement I
enter the structure of the door and feel its vibrational energy as I float effortlessly
through it, keeping my eyes open. The door looks like an energy fog shaped and
formed into an ethereal mold. After floating through the door, I think of standing
and I’m instantly in the living room, standing next to the sofa and looking around
the room. As I look around I notice that a strange small form appears to be
following me. Staring, I recognize our beagle puppy, McGregor. I’m amazed
because I’ve never seen an animal when out-of-body. He appears surprisingly
natural and solid as he wags his tail and looks up at me. I notice that his eyes are
shining and then I see something else: there’s a thin filament like a spider’s web
stretching from his body and extending back toward the bedroom. Out of curiosity I
bend down and touch the thin silvery strand. Instantly, the puppy disappears. I’m
startled by the rapid change and snap back to my physical body.
As my numbness quickly fades, I can feel the dog physically jump up on the bed. I
lie still and review the experience, attempting to put it into perspective. Now more
than ever, I realize how little we know about ourselves and our world. I feel like a
naive schoolboy who has just seen the real world for the first time. It strikes me
how arrogant we are to assume we know anything. We, who don’t know what we
are, why we’re here, or even where we go, consider ourselves the dominant,
intelligent rulers of the world. It’s truly ironic just how deceived we are. It’s even
more laughable that we hold so many firm convictions and conclusions concerning
things we don’t see or understand. Now more than ever, I’m convinced that out-ofbody
exploration can provide the answers to the many mysteries of our existence.
CHAPTER 2
Meetings Out-of-Body
Any sufficiently advanced technology is indistinguishable from magic.
—Arthur C. Clarke
Journal Entry, February 21, 1985
I enter the vibrational state and feel waves of energy flowing through my body. It’s
a soothing sensation of energy radiating from deep within me. As I focus on the
vibrational changes, I feel pulses of energy flowing through me and a distinct
sensation of hands gently touching my body. At first I’m startled, but I quickly
realize that the sensation is comforting and even enjoyable once I get accustomed
to it. The waves of energy seem to increase and decrease in a rhythmical sequence,
and I can feel myself becoming lighter and lighter until I’m completely detached
from my body. I recognize that I’m floating just out of phase with my physical body
and could easily separate at any moment; however, I also sense that I should
remain still and allow the vibrational process to continue, I can feel the subtle touch
of hands as they move from the bottoms of my feet upward along my entire body.
Each touch creates waves of energy resonating through me. It feels as though my
internal vibrational rate is being adjusted to a new energy level or frequency, and I
sense that the person or persons next to me are doing a form of “energy work” on
me. For over twenty minutes the energy currents systematically move and flow
through my nonphysical body. My body and mind seem to resonate with the energy
waves, and I feel an overwhelming sense of peace and unity throughout my being.
Slowly the waves of energy dissipate and my physical sensations return.
My mind is racing with questions: What is this? What is the purpose? What entity or
entities are touching me? One thing is certain, I felt noticeably light and airy for
several hours afterward. My entire body felt as though it was vibrating at a higher
or finer rate. I strongly suspect that I’ve just experienced a vibrational or frequency
adjustment of my nonphysical being. I can only imagine that I may have needed
this energy adjustment in order to expand or enhance my nonphysical explorations.
Even though no one communicated with me, I know that this process was an
important energy adjustment required for my personal development. I also realize
that these energy sensations were completely different from the vibrations I
normally experience during the vibrational phase before separation. I received a
strong sense of direction and purpose as the hands of energy touched me. I believe
that it was one or possibly two entities working on me. Like unseen chiropractors,
they seemed to know precisely what they were doing; each touch altered my
internal vibrational rare at a specific point within my nonphysical body and created
energy waves resonating deep within me. Though startling at first, this was a
thoroughly enjoyable experience that I know will occur again.
Journal Entry, December 5, 1986
I lie in bed visualizing my living room and repeating to myself, “Now I’m out-ofbody,”
for approximately fifteen minutes. After drifting off to sleep, I feel the
vibrations and spontaneously do a sideways roll out of my body. I fall to the floor
and open my eyes. Everything is blurry and I feel extremely heavy and out of sync.
I crawl a few feet and say aloud, “I’m light as a feather.” I feel a surge of inner
energy and I’m instantly lighter and able to stand. As I move away from my bed
my vision remains poor, so I make another request, “Clarity now.” My vision seems
to snap into focus and I immediately stride forward through the wall of my room
and into a bright green environment. Looking around, I realize that I’m in an open
meadow. I feel somewhat confused by the rapid change of surroundings and
spontaneously call aloud, “Where am I?” I suddenly feel the presence of someone
close by, and a series of vivid pictures enters my mind. “You have raised your
vibrational rate when you asked for lightness and again when you asked for clarity.
You have entered a higher-frequency environment that is very close to the
physical.”
I’m amazed at the clarity of the images entering my mind. It’s difficult to describe,
but they’re visual representations of ideas—not words. The communication is far
more direct and precise than words. I understand the meaning and look for the
source, I can feel the energy radiation of someone directly in front of me but can
see nothing. Out of curiosity I call out, “Who are you?” Again the images stream in
my mind. “I’m an old friend who is observing your progress. The feelings instilled in
the images are warm and friendly. I’m completely at ease and firmly make a
request, “I want to see you.” I watch in amazement as the hazy outline of an image
appears. A transparent hologram of a man becomes increasingly dense before me.
He has dark hair and a short beard and wears a long purple robe. He’s about fivefeet-
ten-inches tall, and a broad smile radiates from his face. At first I’m startled by
the reality of his rapid materialization, but he seems to sense my discomfort and a
series of comforting images appears in my mind: “No need for fear. You and I are
old friends.” I somehow sense his friendship and calm down. As I stare at this man,
he seems pleased to see me. He seems to know my thoughts and responds to the
questions that fill my mind. “I’m just as you; the only difference is I don’t possess a
physical vehicle."
“We are friends from long ago and have worked together on numerous projects
within the interior.... You and I have explored far beyond the second membrane.
Now you are exploring the dense region again.... You have a strange fascination
with the physical, one that I don’t share.” There is a brief pause as my questions
form.
“I’m acting as one of your guides. You have several different individuals assisting
you in different aspects of your life. In a way, each person assisting you is a
specialist in a given area of existence. You and I love to explore inward, so I am
here to assist in that part of your life.... You were correct in your conclusion: a
guide would never interfere in the natural evolution of an individual’s personal
development. We realize that we must remain unobserved unless assistance is
requested. Even then, we must appraise the situation and its consequences before
we act.”
My mind is overflowing with endless questions. The being before me seems to
understand and anticipate my thoughts.
His calming thought-images pinpoint specific questions as he continues.
“Each person who has an out-of-body or near-death experience has a guide present
during the experience. Assistance is always available but it must be requested. . . .
There is nothing to fear, but many are still unaware that their thoughts manifest
their reality. As you now know, this can happen instantly. The end result can be
startling to the novice explorer. Most physical inhabitants possess little control over
their thoughts.”
After a brief pause, he continues. “As you are learning, thought control and focus
are absolutely essential. This is especially true as you explore deeper within the
interior of the universe. Your control is getting better, but you still have fears to
overcome.... You felt your fears when I became visible to you; I could tell that you
were wobbling in your energy field and close to reentering your body. ... Always
remember, when we conquer our fears we gain our liberation. . . . Very shortly, you
will experience some new ways to confront your fears, both in the dense body and
in your higher-frequency bodies. Each experience will serve a purpose; each
obstacle is a blessing in disguise.”
At that instant I snap back into my physical body and open my eyes. I feel like I’m
being prepared for something to come, but I don’t have a clue what it could be. I
feel a strange sense of friendship with this man. I sense his positive intentions and
feel somehow more prepared to face the unknown. His last images echo in my
mind: “Each obstacle is a blessing in disguise.” I can’t help but wonder if he’s
explaining my past or preparing me for my future.
As I review this experience, I can’t help but notice some similarities between my
nonphysical friend and the guide described in Paul Twitchell’s books. Even though
the two resemble each other, it seems unlikely that they are the same person. Over
the years, I have met several out-of-body explorers who have described a similarappearing
nonphysical guide. The reason for this is unknown, but I wonder whether
our existing concept of a nonphysical guide or event may influence what we
experience when out-of-body.
Journal Entry, January 3,1987
I feel the vibrations and lift out. I’m standing in my bedroom and, looking around, I
see that the surroundings are similar but not exact. The woodwork and walls are
different from those of my physical home. I move to the door and step through it.
Instantly, I’m in a new environment. A woman that I somehow seem to know
approaches me. She’s tall, with long brown hair and sparkling eyes. She steps close
to me and smiles, “I’ve missed you.” Spontaneously I respond, “Me too.” She kisses
me and warmly takes my hands. Suddenly, we’re in another environment. A
magnificent park-like setting comes into focus. We stand together at the edge of
a crystal blue-green pond. Everything around me—the trees, the grass, the pond—
are vibrantly alive. As I look at the woman, an intense feeling of love swells inside
me. She stares at me and holds both my hands. “You travel so much. I need you
here.” I hold her close. “I’m here now."
Her face and body seem to shine like ten thousand points of light. We kiss and a
surge of energy floods into my mind. Our bodies and minds come together in an
intense explosion of pure energy and joy. Our thoughts merge and touch one
another in a thousand subtle ways. I feel immersed in her mind as she and I
become as one. The ecstasy is beyond words. For the first time, I feel complete and
whole.
I think to myself, My God, I don’t want it to end. With a jolt, I’m snapped back into
my body. My entire being seems to vibrate at a lighter, finer level than I’ve ever
known before. Even my physical body feels different—somehow brighter, lighter,
and energized beyond my conception. I lie in bed and enjoy the waves of energy
that flow throughout my body and mind. The sensations last for several minutes. I
remain still and enjoy every moment. For many weeks after this experience, I
pondered its meaning. Was this sex in the inner worlds or was it a unification of
my conscious mind with a higher aspect of myself? I feel that I should know the
answer, but I don’t.
Journal Entry, October 15, 1988
I repeat my regular affirmation as I drift to sleep, “Now I’m out-of-body.” Within
seconds I’m floating above my body and direct myself to the foot of the bed. Out of
habit I say aloud, “Clarity now.” Instantly my awareness becomes clear and I
spontaneously think about exploring. There’s a sense of rapid motion and I’m
standing in a magnificent park-like courtyard. As I focus, I see around me a dozen
people riding bikes and roller-skating. The courtyard is the size of a football field,
with several large trees and a stonewall border about eight feet high. I notice that
one woman is pushing a baby stroller and two boys are throwing a ball back and
forth. The entire environment feels happy and relaxed. I’m especially interested in
the baby stroller—I’ve never seen an infant when out-of-body.
To my surprise a smiling, red-haired girl about twelve years old skates over to me
and asks, “You’re new here, aren’t you?”
I respond, “I guess I am.”
Out of nowhere it starts to rain and everyone in the courtyard scrambles for cover.
I’m amazed. In fifteen years, I’ve never seen weather changes when out-of-body.
The girl stares at me and points to shelter under a tree. “Come on. Let’s go over
there.”
I can’t believe how real the softly falling rain seems. As I enjoy feeling it flow down
my face, I wonder if this is a consensus environment. Out of curiosity I focus all my
attention on stopping the rain. The girl stares at me as if I’m crazy.
“What are you doing?”
“I’m stopping the rain.”
Instantly the rain stops. The girl continues to stare and asks, “Are you a traveler?”
I feel a slight tugging sensation at the center of my hack and know I have to leave.
“I’ve got to go.”
She looks deeply disappointed and says, “Will you come back?”
As I look at her face I snap back into my physical body. A tingling sensation quickly
fades as my physical senses return.
Opening my eyes, I can vividly see the girl’s face in my mind. For some unknown
reason I miss her. I feel I know her but I can’t remember how or where. It’s kind of
frustrating because I know there’s a connection. I’ve realized for some time that
coincidence is nonexistent. I also wonder about her question, “Are you a traveler?”
Journal Entry, September 16, 1989
As I drift off to sleep, I repeat my normal affirmation, “Now I’m out of body,” thirty
to forty times. As much as possible, I intensify and hold my affirmation as my last
conscious thought before going to sleep. I awaken to a slight vibration and sense of
rapid motion. After several seconds I find myself standing in a multileveled parking
structure. In the distance I can see ramps heading up and down. As I look around,
an unusual sight attracts my attention. A shiny new car is half-buried in a pile of
dirt. It looks so strange that I’m drawn to it. I think to myself, Who would do this to
a beautiful new car? For some reason, I have an overpowering need to look inside
and begin to brush the dirt away from the windows and doors. As I work, I realize
that this is a huge job before me. Even so, I continue to dig handfuls of dirt away
from the windows. Finally, a window is clear and I peer inside. Instead of a normal
interior, I see a radiant white light permeating the inside of the car. The light seems
vibrantly alive with energy and life. I feel an intense inner connection to the light
and an overwhelming need to open the car door. With increased intensity, my
hands tear at the dirt and slowly clear another window.
Out of nowhere a car pulls up beside me with a young man inside. I immediately
sense that we know each other quite well, but I can’t remember how or when. He
smiles as he speaks.
“You’ve got a lot of work ahead of you.”
Surprised by his presence, I nod in agreement and walk over to his car.
“Would you like to help?”
He seems amused by my request and replies, “Each of us must free ourselves.”
His words seem to ring in my mind as I instantly snap back to my physical body.
My physical senses quickly return as I ponder the experience. More than ever, I
realize that my mind is interpreting my out-of-body experiences based upon my
current physical concepts, symbols, and images. It’s apparent that a higher part of
myself is orchestrating my experiences in a manner that’s appropriate for my
current understanding. I recognize and understand the dreamlike imagery of this
experience, but I question whether it is necessary. In my mind, the experience is
clear. I am striving to free my inner energy-self, my soul. The dirt represents all
the negative trash that I’ve collected and accepted over the years—attachments,
fears, limits, all the negative attributes and emotions I am working to remove. My
personal dirt is limiting, blocking, and restricting the light of my soul from shining
forth. I can’t help but wonder what would happen if I demanded to see the true
energy source represented by the form.
Now, for the first time, I fully understand that many of the forms I see when outof-
body are created for my benefit. They are manifested for my comprehension.
Our minds are obviously conditioned to react to forms, not to pure energy.
Increasingly it’s clear that my higher mind or soul is creating the outer forms I
perceive in order to teach me what I need to know. Now I feel ready to see the
reality behind the forms. Next time, I’m going to ask to see the actual raw energy
behind all the forms that I perceive.
Journal Entry, January 24, 1990
I feel the vibrations and direct myself away from my physical body. Within seconds
I’m standing at my bedroom door. Out of habit I verbally request clarity and
guidance. Suddenly I feel an intense inner motion, and within seconds I find myself
at the entrance of a large stone building. The size and shape of the building are like
nothing I’ve seen before; the structure extends to the horizon and appears to be
extremely old. In front of me is a set of fifteen-foot-high brass-and-wood doors.
Upon entering I see an open room leading to an endless series of corridors. I walk
through the open area and enter the closest corridor. All around me are huge
rooms filled with forms and objects that appear the same. On closer examination,
though, I notice that the objects are slightly different; they appear to be a
progression, or possibly an evolution, of the same object. In another room are
hundreds of toys, each slightly different in form and structure. I have no interest in
the objects and proceed down a long hallway. I realize that I’m in an area that is
vacant and appears unused. In front of me are timbers blocking a double door.
Using all my strength, I push the timbers out of my way and open the door. Behind
the door is an engine or power room of some kind. Directly in front of me is a
mammoth engine, three stories tall and the size of a football field. Somewhat
confused I say aloud, “What does this represent?” A stream of vivid images appears
in my mind. “This is the power source behind the forms you see. Your mind is
attempting to relate to concepts it can comprehend. True power has no shape or
form.” The engine fades from my sight, and an overpowering sensation of pure
energy radiates before me. Focusing, I see waves of light emanating from a single
source.
As I stare, the light becomes blinding. A part of me wants to turn away, but I don’t.
It feels as if the outer layers of myself are being burned away—my old concepts,
beliefs, assumptions, and conclusions are incinerated by the intensity of the light. I
can take no more and scream out, “What is this?” Instantly, I’m drawn within the
light. My mind is overwhelmed as I realize that I have merged with a greater, more
expansive part of myself. I suddenly understand that I am the engine of my life—
I’m the creative force within me. I recognize that I have separated from myself. For
several moments, the light and I are one. I feel a deep peace and
interconnectiveness I have never known before. For the first time I realize that I
can create whatever reality I choose—my creative power is beyond my
comprehension. I now know that I have limited myself by the ideas and beliefs I
have accepted, and I recognize the need to release all my limits, fears, and
expectations. A profound sense of empowerment sweeps through me as I scream
inside, I will remember this.
Instantly, I snap back within my physical body. As my physical senses return, I
review the experience and realize that I can remember everything in detail but feel
a deep sense of separation. I miss the unity, the oneness. As I lie in bed I know
that I’ve experienced a more expansive part of myself. Whether we call it
our higher self, our creative mind, or our soul is unimportant. But I absolutely know
that this is a part of me that possesses complete access to the answers. For some
reason I seem to know that this huge building was similar to a museum—possibly a
living record of all forms, or even all things that will be made. I realize that my
mind was interpreting the forms I witnessed in relation to my current physical
surroundings. It’s taken me a long time, but I’m finally learning that it’s not the
forms we see that are important; it’s what the forms represent. This recognition
appears to be a major step forward. As strange as it may sound, I strongly suspect
that the same holds true for the physical world around us.
Journal Entry, February 6, 1990
I fall asleep without doing any techniques but awaken at 1:00 A.M. in the
vibrational stage. I quickly sit up within my physical body and look around. I’m
startled by the sight of a man next to my bed looking through my journal. He sees
me sitting up and jumps back. I am extremely angered by his presence and yell at
him, “Who are you?”
He steps away from my bed, appearing shocked and frightened by my appearance.
He is a fat, unshaven, middle-aged man with short hair and stands about five-feeteight-
inches tall. He continues to back away from me as I shout even louder, “Who
the hell are you?” A combination of anger and fear explodes from me as I yell, “Get
the hell out, get the hell out!”
He turns and runs out of my bedroom and I instantly snap back within my body. I
am shouting in my physical body as I return and my mumbled cries awaken my
wife. Startled, I sit up and look around.
Slowly, I calm down and review the experience. I realize that I probably
overreacted, but the sight of this strange man in my bedroom created an instant
self-defensive response. I couldn’t sleep the rest of the night, wondering who this
man was. Try as I might, I couldn’t place his face. He seemed to be extremely
interested in my writing; perhaps he was even spying on me. In retrospect, I
probably scared him more than he scared me. After some thought, I have
concluded that he was probably one of the millions of inhabitants living within the
first inner energy dimension. It’s possible that my out-of-body experiences made
him curious about what I was writing and he was simply checking it out.
I can’t help but wonder how often all of us are visited by other-dimensional
inhabitants. In addition, I seriously question our concepts of privacy. I suspect that
there’s something more to this experience than I currently understand.
Journal Entry, March 14, 1991
I feel the vibrations and will myself to the door. Out of habit I ask for “Clarity now!”
My awareness is remarkably good and I instinctively say aloud, “I move inward.” I
feel an intense inner motion for several seconds and come to an abrupt halt. My
entire being is immersed in a wondrous liquid light. I feel completely peaceful and
at home. A warm glowing feeling of total love surrounds me. As I focus, all my
questions seem to become instantly clear. A simple request fills my awareness, “I
need to see my life.” Instantly, crystal-clear pictures appear before me. A series of
three-dimensional pictures expands and unfolds; hundreds, then thousands, then
tens of thousands of pictures come into focus. I instinctively know that each picture
is of me. I focus on one. The picture is alive. I’m a small boy wearing a tunic and
sandals; the floors and walls are stone and marble. This is me two thousand years
ago. I’m neither shocked nor surprised—I just seem to know. Like a memory of an
event long forgotten, this moment in time passes briefly before me. Then I pull
back my attention and look at the countless other pictures that come alive before
me. Each one is my life: some on earth, others occurring in nonphysical areas of
the universe.
As I observe these events they seem to make sense: each event, each life, was a
necessary step; each one achieved a specific purpose. Like the pieces to a puzzle,
each picture falls into place, each contributing to the whole. Each picture, each
experience, was needed to create the sum of what I am today. Suddenly, I’m
overwhelmed by the magnificence and wisdom of all that I observe. I see the good
and the bad, the triumphs and the defeats. I see my countless weaknesses and
faults and my occasional strengths. Suddenly it hits me that I’m witnessing my
evolution through thousands of years of living. Each individual life was a step, an
experience of growth; each life built upon the previous one. A sense of joy flows
through me as I understand the need for hardships and adversity. Each challenge
was an important learning situation, a learning environment especially created for
my development. I see the wisdom of it all. I’m the student and the teacher; I’m
the writer, director, and actor of my life. An inner realization floods through me:
the only way to know and understand something absolutely is to experience it for
yourself. Anything less is theory and speculation. The staggering truth becomes
clear: physical life is an interactive school, a relentless training ground for
developing souls.
In fascination I stare at my life before me. Countless years and experiences all
contributed to what I am today. The expanse of time was unimportant. I recognize
that I am immortal and that time is meaningless. As soul, as pure awareness, I
need no artificial device like time to track change. As soul, I never age or
deteriorate; I only grow in knowledge and experience. Each of my explorations into
matter increased my knowledge. Each physical journey expanded my vision and my
appreciation of life. Each physical experience gave me the opportunity to develop
and grow, the opportunity to express my inner qualities of love, humility, patience,
and strength. I am comforted by the simplicity of it all. It makes perfect sense:
experience creates wisdom. Time is irrelevant. Deep within ourselves we keep a
permanent record of each experience. Each event, each moment, is recorded in our
subconscious mind. As I stare at the pictures of my life, I realize that the physical
events were only a small portion of the whole. I lived in countless different forms,
in countless worlds. A feeling of compassion flows through me as I recognize the
purpose. The entire universe, physical and nonphysical, is a training school for
developing souls. I clearly see schools within schools, dimensions
within dimensions, all serving as an interactive learning environment. Each energy
level of the universe is serving a specific purpose. Each is providing specific
challenges and opportunities for growth, for evolution. A sense of purpose and
order becomes clear: I’m witnessing the evolution of consciousness, the evolution
of myself through eons of time. My awareness overflows with love and gratitude.
For the first time in my life, everything around me makes perfect sense. At that
instant I return to my body with a warm feeling of love and knowledge radiating
through every cell of my being.
For the first time, I understand my purpose and reason for being. With each out-ofbody
experience I continued to examine the nonphysical forms I encountered. At
first they appeared to be holographic images with substance. On closer inspection, I
discovered that they were every bit as real and solid as physical matter. These
nonphysical objects appeared to consist of a matrix of light energy instead of
molecular energy. For years, I didn’t comprehend the implications, but as my
experiences continued I began to realize that all life, physical and nonphysical, is
interconnected. In addition, I discovered that each physical object around us exists
as a multiple-frequency object. Everything around us also exists in a parallel,
nonphysical dimension of the universe. Although our eyes see only the dense
molecular result of energy, matter continues in a continuum of nonphysical energy
beyond our sight. Each form is independent of the physical yet is interconnected by
its internal frequency, just as particles of light and waves of light are
interconnected as a single unit of energy.
Matter exists as a continuum of energy extending far beyond the crude limits of our
physical vision. This is an important realization because it explains the very
existence of all form and substance observed throughout the nonphysical interior of
the universe. It also explains the multidimensional nature of everything we observe
when out-of-body. For example, when we observe physical light, we see only a tiny
portion of the entire electromagnetic spectrum. Yet each of us is immersed in a sea
of radiation frequencies: X rays, infrared rays, radio waves, and microwaves. Just
as visible light makes up only a fraction of the electromagnetic wave spectrum, so
visible matter composes only a tiny portion of the entire multidimensional
(frequency) energy-universe. The vast majority of the universe is not particle
based, as current science assumes, but frequency based. Physical particles of
matter are simply the dense result of nonphysical energy frequencies (waves). Just
as visible light is not only a particle of energy but also a wave temporarily
exhibiting particle behavior, so our entire physical universe is not just molecular
energy but a continuum of energy frequencies extending deep into the heart of the
multidimensional universe. Simply put, all objects and life-forms are
multidimensional in nature. Everything around us is multidimensional,
simultaneously existing in different energy frequencies of the universe. Yet all these
energy dimensions coexist in the same time and space, just as radio waves,
microwaves, X rays, and visible light exist together, each within its own frequency
band.
Journal Entry, April 12, 1991
I enter the vibrational state and will myself to the bedroom door. I’m slightly out of
focus and say aloud, “Clarity now!” Immediately my vision improves and I step
through the bedroom door. I stop my forward motion and decide to explore inward
instead of walking around my house. Spontaneously I call out, “I move inward.”
Instantly, I feel an intense inner motion that lasts for several seconds—it’s as if I’m
being drawn into a vacuum of space. The sense of motion abruptly stops and I’m
standing in front of an oceanfront home. The house sits about ten feet in the air,
resting on twelve-inch-thick wooden pillars.
My vision is slightly foggy so I ask for clarity again. My vision snaps into focus and I
think about entering the house. Almost instantly I’m inside. As I look around,
everything seems familiar. I feel completely comfortable and, for some reason, am
absolutely certain that this is my nonphysical home. The wall facing the ocean is
made of glass. As I move closer to the glass I notice that the corners are curved
like plastic. It looks like a home of the future filled with things from the past; all the
furniture, artwork, and rugs appear to be antiques. Looking around, I clearly see
my lion-head rocking chair facing the ocean. As I stare, I recognize that this could
be my home in the future. I don’t know if it’s my physical future or a possible
future after my death, but I do know that it’s a reality existing now. Feeling
completely at home, I walk over to the glass wall and peer out at the ocean. The
sound of the ocean is magnificent. Instead of pounding surf there is a strong
rhythmic harmony, like a song. I listen intently, trying to recognize the melody.
Instinctively, I open the door and step out onto a huge deck overlooking the ocean.
The music of the waves is almost hypnotic in its beauty. The sound seems to move
through me; it resonates deep within my body and mind. It’s hard to describe, but
the ocean seems to radiate love. As the music flows through me, it feels as if I’m
being caressed by the vibrations of the song.
As I look at the ocean, I’m amazed at the changing colors of the waves. It’s like
nothing I’ve ever seen before. Shimmering hues merge and blend to form endless
swirls of vivid color. The colors are beyond description, millions of shades and tints
changing and mixing to form a flowing light show of indescribable beauty.
My mind is lost in the vibrations and song of the ocean. I feel completely at peace,
my entire being resonating with the music of the song. I feel a need to merge with
the ocean, but inwardly I’m afraid that I could be swallowed up and drown. My
indecision suddenly becomes clear and I recognize my fear; I thought that I had
overcome my fears, but now it’s obvious that I have considerable work ahead of
me. As I try to analyze this realization, I’m snapped back to my body. The
numbness and tingling sensations quickly fade as I ponder the experience.
I realize that this is the second time I’ve been in this house. The first time was at a
meeting I attended with several people. This house feels so much like home, I
wonder if it’s where I lived before I was physically born. Even more, I wonder about
the ocean of color and music. I suspect that the ocean is my mind’s interpretation
of something that’s beyond my comprehension. I can only guess that it’s a sea of
consciousness, or maybe my mind’s interpretation of God itself. Perhaps both of
these are the same. I still don’t know, but I’m sure I’m getting closer to the
answer.
Journal Entry, October 24, 1992
I repeat my favorite affirmation aloud for five to ten minutes: “Now I’m out-ofbody.”
As I drift off, I intensify the affirmations in my mind. I awaken to the
sensations of strong vibrations surging through my body. Immediately I focus my
full attention on the idea of floating to my bedroom door. Within seconds I feel
myself lift and float to the door. Then, with a sense of exhilaration, I walk though
the door and into the living room. As I look around, I realize that I’m in my first
(densest) energy-body and have a sudden overwhelming urge to explore. Almost
shouting, I verbally make a firm request, “I want to see more.” Instantly, a
sensation of rapid motion draws me inward. I feel as if I’m being drawn into a
vacuum, and in seconds I’m in a new environment. I’m startled and blinded by the
intensity of the surrounding light. When I instinctually attempt to shield myself
from the radiation, I realize that my body is without form—no arms or legs, just
energy. I try to comprehend that I have no shape whatsoever. I seem like light
without a distinctive outer form. My vision is endless.
All around, pure energy emanates; there are no shapes or forms, just radiation of
light. I’m drawn to what appears to be a column of pure white light. As I move
closer to the light, the sheer power of its radiation is overpowering. I stop and try
to adjust. The energy is so intense it feels like the outer parts of me are being
burned away. My entire outer self—my thoughts, fears, and concepts—is being
incinerated by the light. At first, I try to shield myself. I surround myself with
thoughts only to realize that they too are being burned away by the intensity of the
light. Unsure of what to do, I instinctively release and surrender myself to the light.
At that moment, the light enters me like a warm liquid permeating my body and
mind.
My entire being is filled with light, and every part of me seems to resonate at a new
frequency. I relax and enjoy the sensation of pure energy flowing through me.
Deep within, I realize that something of extreme importance is before me. There is
something else within the column of light. No longer afraid, I have an overpowering
desire to know and understand the light, I move closer and try to peer inside. The
pure energy and power are beyond words; I feel like I’m standing next to a blazing
white sun that radiates waves of light. Somehow I know that I’m safe, and I slowly
move forward and touch the light. An intense surge of energy flows through my
entire being. I’m suddenly immersed in an ocean of pure knowledge. I’m flooded
with memories of all I’ve been, all I’ve done, all that I am. Everything is now. I’m
overwhelmed by the absolute simplicity of it all. For the first time, everything is
clear. Everything we are and need is already here. For the first time, I recognize
that we have separated ourselves from our source. How foolish we are. We focus
on decaying molecular forms when true reality is always here, patiently waiting for
us to open our eyes and see. An overpowering feeling of love, a deep feeling of
compassion for everything that is, permeates my being. I realize that we are all
interconnected in an ocean of living light. The separateness we feel is but the dense
illusion of molecular form. My awareness comes alive with the realization that my
mind and its capabilities are but another temporary vehicle of expression. We exist
beyond thought, beyond time, beyond linear cause and effect.
I’m overwhelmed by endless waves of pure knowledge. My mind is filled beyond its
limits, and I realize that this is more than I can ever hope to remember. I scream
out, “I will remember this.” Instantly I’m snapped back to my body and attempt to
open my eyes. I’m unable to move and recognize that I’m in a cataleptic state.
Slowly, I can feel a numbness and tingling spread through my physical body. After
about a minute, I can move my fingers and toes. I lie still and review the
experience with a feeling of awe. I absolutely know that the column of light was
really me—not just another part of me, but the pure me, the very essence of all I
am. Is it possible that we are really that incredible? Now I feel separated and alone;
yet, at the same time, I feel connected to something far greater than I’ve ever
imagined. My mind races with realizations, more than I can begin to comprehend.
I now recognize that we as human beings have a natural tendency to attach labels
to everything we experience and to filter it according to our physical concepts and
beliefs. I wonder if all shapes and forms are really our minds’ interpretation of
something else—something that exists beyond all form and substance; something
so pure and ethereal as to be beyond our minds’ ability to classify and interpret. It’s
possible that our recognition of this is a major step forward in and of itself. Maybe
the constant infighting between different religions, faiths, and sects would finally
come to an end if we only recognized that all religious beliefs are the physical
interpretations of mortals. It’s now absolutely clear that God does not care about
our personal theology. Our physical beliefs are all rooted in temporary forms and
substance; they are all but a passing moment in time.
What really matters is experience, spiritual experience. It appears that the purpose
of the entire universe is experience—firsthand, gut-wrenching, personal experience.
Nothing can replace it. It’s now clear that personal experience is the road to
wisdom that we all share. As I expanded my exploration beyond the first inner
dimension, I began to notice some unusual sights. In some areas, clouds of energy
dominated the environment. I was especially amazed to see some of these clouds
taking specific forms. I saw what appeared to be cars, homes, even cruise ships
partially created.
After years of experience, I have concluded that these items are the direct result of
human thought. The environments within the nonphysical dimensions are made of
thought-responsive energy. Thoughts appear to be innately capable of rearranging
the subtle energies that make up the unseen dimensions. I have found that the
natural energy-substance of the inner dimensions appears as cloudlike forms of
energy. In a sense, this energy is an easily manipulated radiation of light. It
appears that the building blocks of the unseen dimensions are not particles (atoms
and quarks) but waves or frequencies of energy and light. When I examined the
energy clouds, it became apparent that they exist as clusters of raw, unformed
energy—much like holograms that are slowly growing and changing in form and
density.
Journal Entry, April 12, 1991
I feel the vibrations and will myself to the foot of the bed. I feel a little hazy and
out of focus, so I immediately demand complete clarity. Instantly, my conscious
mind seems to snap in gear; my thoughts become clear. My mind is alive and
racing with excitement as I say to myself, “This is better than my physical brain.”
Suddenly I feel an intense inner need to discover my past life. Spontaneously I say
loudly, “I need to know my past life.” Instantly, there’s a sensation of inner motion
and I find myself in a completely new environment. I’m surrounded by an incredible
scene of destruction. As I look down a long city street I see nothing but demolished
buildings. I realize that my upper body is extending through the hatch of a tank.
Then it hits me that I’m seeing through the eyes of this other man— the soldier. I
am this man; I feel his thoughts and emotions.
I’m extremely arrogant and self-assured and feel strangely powerful as I look at the
burning buildings and rubble around me. I’m proud of what I’ve done. I’m a tank
commander, a German panzer commander. Somehow I know that the city is
Warsaw, Poland, and that my soldiers and I have just conquered it. My tank grinds
to a halt at the center of what used to be a major city intersection. Several tanks
around me fire, and entire blocks of buildings collapse before me. I am pleased with
myself. Holding some kind of device, I bark orders to a tank on my right. As I look
at my arm, I notice that my uniform is black and is covered with gray powder.
Suddenly, an intense sense of motion, like a vacuum, snaps me back into my
physical body. I open my eyes and feel a numbness and tingling as I reunite with
the physical.
I’m startled and amazed at the intensity of the experience. I was not just an
observer but an active participant. For a few moments I felt what this man felt—I
was this man. I feel disappointed with myself; I had envisioned myself as
something more than an arrogant German officer. Maybe this explains my current
antiwar sentiment and also my fascination with World War II documentaries. If this
German tank commander was indeed my last physical life, I wonder just how much
of him influences me now. A realization sweeps through me that he may affect me
more than I would like to admit. As I look at myself as objectively as possible, a
flood of new insights comes to light. I seriously wonder just how arrogant,
demanding, and aloof I am now. Do I still bark orders and expect to be instantly
obeyed? I wonder just how much of me is influenced and molded by my past. How
strong is this influence? It appears that an unlimited amount of self-knowledge is
available if we are willing to pursue it. I can’t help but be curious. How many past
lives have I experienced? How deeply have they influenced me? How much could I
learn from knowing the answers?
Journal Entry, December 7, 1992
I enter the vibrational state and float approximately two feet above my body.
Determined to experience my finer vibratory body, I say aloud, “I experience my
higher body.” After a brief sensation of motion, I’m floating in a different form. I
feel calm and energized and sense a smoother internal energy. Inwardly, I know
I’ve shifted to my inner energy-body. But I feel out of sync and my vision is hazy,
so I demand complete clarity of awareness, “Clarity now!” Immediately my
thoughts are clear. I feel extremely light and overflowing with energy. At that
moment, my goal flashes in my mind: “I wish to visit another system.” Instantly,
I’m moving through a dark void at incredible speed. At first I’m startled by the
speed, but I relax and adapt to the new sensations. Within seconds I’m floating in
space. I look down at myself and see that there is little to see: my form has no
arms or legs; I’m like a spherical form of conscious energy. For some reason, I’m
not surprised—it seems completely natural that arms and legs are unnecessary in
whatever state I’m in. I slowly rotate and focus on the spectacular sights around
me. In awe, I stare at things I’ve never even imagined before. Clusters of lights are
everywhere, thousands of them, like Christmas lights strung across the heavens. I
feel as if I’m floating in an ocean of lights.
My attention is diverted to something I have never seen before: a hazy foglike form
is visible. The form extends as far as I can see. It looks like an immense curtain of
dense fog except that it appears stable, a permanent fixture hanging in space. I ask
for clarity and find myself floating at a different vantage point, several miles from
the hazy form. Now I see it more clearly. It’s larger than my mind can comprehend,
stretching across the heavens like an endless border. Suddenly, I sense the
vibrational energy of someone close by, an intense radiation without form or
substance. I am instantly aware of communication, like a series of clear pictures
appearing in my mind.
The following is a little disjointed but as close as words can explain the inner
meaning of the pictures.
“Beautiful, is it not?”
I roll over to see who it is. My awareness is blinded by the intensity of the light. I
begin to back away and shield myself from the crushing energy. The entity
continues to communicate with my mind.
“I will adjust.”
The radiation immediately diminishes. I can’t perceive a form, only light.
“I have no form as you understand it. Form is unnecessary. Not many of your kind
venture this far in.”
I am unable to respond—my mind is overwhelmed, and I don’t know where to
begin. The energy being must sense my dilemma and begins to respond.
“What you see before you is one of many wonders of the universe. The infinity of
fog you see is one of the many inner membranes dividing different frequencies of
the universe. What you are witnessing is the inner structure of the universe. The
stars and galaxies you see in the distance are but the outer crust of the universe.
The key to true exploration is the movement through the energy membranes. As
you move farther inward, toward the source, your internal energy frequency must
change accordingly. You can only cross through the energy barriers that are in
accordance with your inner light. What you see before you is the key to stability
and structure throughout the universe.”
I’m amazed at the clarity of the pictures entering my mind. This being seems to
automatically know my thoughts.
“All conscious energy (souls) live within the energy frequency that is in phase with
their personal vibratory rate. The membrane before you separates one wavelength
of energy from another.”
As I stare, I can’t think of an appropriate response. I feel inadequate, like a child
raking an advanced calculus class. The energy being again responds to my
thoughts.
“You are ready or you would not be here. All of us are where we should be. I was
once as you and you shall be as I; we are all on a great journey together. Your
perception of me is inaccurate. I am but a child compared to others who dwell
within the universe. The possible evolution of consciousness is unlimited. My
identity is unimportant and labels are unnecessary. Remember well what you see,
for the recognition and exploration of the energy membranes will have a significant
impact upon the evolution of your species.”
I’m somewhat confused by the speed of the information entering my mind and ask
for clarification.
“I don’t understand. The purpose for the energy membranes?”
“They simply separate different frequencies of energy from each other. You are
observing the convergence point of two different dimensions. Energy membranes
provide the necessary substructure for each dimension to exist. They are the
internal cell walls of the living universe.”
“My God, that’s incredible.”
“There is much to see. Your adventure is just beginning.”
“How do you mean?”
“You will see soon enough.”
“I still don’t understand.”
“You will, my friend, you will.”
I snap back to my physical body with a jolt. At first I’m out of sync and unable to
move. After twenty seconds or so I feel my physical sensations returning.
After twenty years of out-of-body experiences, I have found that there is a natural
tendency for our nonphysical bodies to become progressively less dense as the
experience continues. It appears that our personal frequency rate slowly returns to
its “normal” or natural vibrational state. Our nonphysical body slowly adjusts to the
vibrational frequency (internal density) that is our natural state of being. This
process of internal adjustment is reported by several serious out-of-body explorers.
Robert Monroe refers to this change when he describes his nonphysical form
becoming progressively “less humanoid” in shape as the time duration of his out-ofbody
experience lengthens. This tendency for us to return to our natural internal
frequency rate has another important implication. On countless occasions I’ve
noticed that when I’m out-of-body for more than several minutes, the observed
environment slowly fades and a new environment becomes visible. For years I
thought my vision was simply adjusting to its expanded abilities to perceive. But
now I realize that this is only part of it. When we are out-of-body our nonphysical
form is not static, as it may first appear, but is actually an expansive energy
system that fluctuates in its internal energy frequency. This becomes especially
noticeable as we control and extend our nonphysical experiences. In other words,
the nonphysical body is not a body at all but a highly sophisticated energy system
that responds to our thoughts. As we prolong our nonphysical adventures, our
consciousness has a natural tendency to return to its true nonphysical state. As
strange as this may sound, I’m now certain that our concepts related to form,
shape, and substance are all temporary conditions. It appears that, as soul, we are
without form of any kind. Our true self is not humanoid as we now conceive
ourselves. Soul or pure consciousness is without form but can, and does, use
various shapes and forms of energy for its purposes.
In November 1993 I developed an acute case of pneumonia and was bedridden for
ten days. During my illness I became extremely weak, didn’t eat, and slept twelve
hours a day. By the third day, I noticed a dramatic increase in my out-of-body
experiences. Each time I drifted off to sleep, I would find myself floating just above
or near my physical body. As my illness progressed, I experienced a coinciding
increase in spontaneous out-of-body experiences. It seemed as if the connection
between my physical and nonphysical body was growing progressively weaker as
my illness continued. At the peak of my pneumonia and for several days thereafter,
I felt a sense of freedom I had never known before. While lying in bed, I would
spontaneously slip out-of-body whenever my physical body dozed off to sleep.
Sometimes it felt as if I wasn’t connected to my physical body at all. I began to use
my physical body like a reference point or staging area to regroup between
nonphysical explorations. For over a week I became so detached that I viewed my
physical body as a necessary encumbrance to be endured. During this time I
experienced a dramatic increase in cluster out-of-body experiences—generally, two
to five separate experiences occurring in sequence. Each experience was quite
short, lasting from thirty seconds to several minutes. On a few occasions, I noticed
that the sequence of events seemed to address a related topic or subject. For
example, one afternoon I dozed off while reading a book about past-life
regressions. Almost immediately I felt the vibrations and was floating above my
body. As I floated comfortably, my thoughts turned to the possibility of past lives
and I immediately felt a sensation of movement.
Journal Entry, November 29, 1993
I am standing at the ramparts of a castle as smoke rises from below. A battle has
raged for several days and I’m exhausted and sick of fighting. I realize that I’m
some sort of medieval soldier. We have been under siege for over two months, and
for the first time in my life I question why we’re fighting. It seems so meaningless.
For the last five years I’ve been fighting and killing and I’ve had enough. The only
things that keep me going are my pride and my sense of duty. After twenty years
of loyal service to my king, I own nothing but a sword and the armor on my back.
As I look around, I’m amazed at how real this is. I’m more than just an observer: I
somehow feel this man’s thoughts and emotions, his pain and disappointment. I
feel I am this man, yet I know I’m not. I experience a great sense of sorrow and
disgust, a life filled with empty victories. I realize now that duty and honor alone
are not enough. I know there must be more to life, but I know only weapons and
the art of war. With a sudden jolt I feel a sharp pain and pressure in my back and
begin to loose consciousness. At that moment I feel the familiar tingling sensations
and recognize that I’m back in my physical body. I think of floating and
immediately rise above my body. I’m amazed at the clarity of my thoughts and
ponder the meaning of the soldier’s experience. I feel a shift of my awareness and
a sense of rapid inner motion. Within seconds, I’m in a completely new
environment.
I’m seated on a stone floor. All around me are dozens of bald-headed monks sitting
in ceremonial meditation. Somehow I know that I’m a Buddhist monk. I can smell
burning musky incense and hear bells and rhythmic chanting. Three dozen of us are
sitting in a circle around an altar. A thin column of white smoke rises from the
center of the altar as a bald-headed boy, about twelve years old, walks around us
chanting and swinging a large, ornate incense holder. He appears to be in a trance.
I can feel myself rocking gently back and forth as I softly chant a phrase that
seems to be a part of me. I and all those around me are wearing orange robes, and
as I look down at my hands I realize that I’m very old—my hands and wrists are
thin and frail. I am content with my life, completely free of all needs and desires.
My mind is at peace. I know I will soon die. With a slight sense of motion I’m back
in my bed. Even though I am in my body, I feel completely out of phase with it, as
if I’m floating within it. My mind is still focused upon the meaning of the monk
experience when I again feel an inward motion. I am incredibly cold. My body and
mind are numb. It’s beyond my endurance to endure. All around me are the frozen
corpses of my friends and fellow soldiers. The ground is too frozen to bury them, so
they lie where they fell. My tank has become an icy tomb.
My mind and body are a hollow broken shell of my former self. My will to live is
gone. Thirty yards away I see two ragged soldiers pull the boots off a dead man.
Beside me, a taunt, nearly lifeless man, a friend of mine, mumbles something to
me. I can’t hear him so I lean closer.
“For God’s sake, kill me.”
I cannot. I lack the courage and the strength to move. The snow is falling again and
I know I’ll soon be dead. A pounding sound is heard in the distance; the Russians
will be here soon. I feel no fear, no hate—I feel nothing at all. I close my eyes and
slip into unconsciousness.
Whether these three experiences were past lives or not, I cannot prove. I do know,
however, that they were as real and vivid as any physical experience I’ve ever had.
It seems wise to remain nonjudgmental when we are exploring new dimensions of
energy. Our minds have a natural tendency to be influenced by our physical
preconceptions of reality. The key to understanding is to remain as open-minded as
possible.
During the time I was ill, I also began to realize how easily out-of-body experiences
can be controlled if we just remember to request clarity on a regular basis. The
simple, firm request for clarity of thought and vision has a tremendous effect upon
our out-of-body state of consciousness. Repeating the clarity technique, I found it
possible to prolong out-of-body experiences for several hours. During my illness I
would sometimes amuse myself by moving back and forth between my physical
body and my floating nonphysical body. While doing this, I discovered an odd state
of consciousness that I refer to as dual consciousness. I found that sometimes I
was able to shift a percentage of my awareness between my physical and my
nonphysical body. It’s possible to perceive with both forms simultaneously and to
adjust or shift the percentage of our awareness between our bodies. In other
words, for brief periods we can simultaneously experience the physical world and a
nonphysical environment with varying degrees of effectiveness. I also found that it
was possible to control the movement of consciousness between the first and
second energy-body. By force of will, we can control this shift of awareness; the
key is to remain focused and centered and mentally ask to experience the second
form. Always remember, once we are no longer attached to a specific form—
whether matter or energy—we are free to move beyond it.
My interest in physics increased with the number of out-of-body experiences I had.
When out-of-body, I would closely observe the energy structures around me. I
became fascinated with the nonphysical forms and substances I encountered. I
recognized that each environment and dimension within the interior of the universe
has specific similarities and differences. The most significant difference appears to
be the degree of responsiveness to thought of a given nonphysical environment.
Some nonphysical environments are easily molded by thought while others are
extremely resistant. I believe that all nonphysical energy is thought-responsive;
however, when a group of individuals maintains the same image or beliefs, the
group creates, molds, and maintains a consensus reality. In effect, group thoughtenergy
forms, stabilizes, and actually solidifies nonphysical energy. The larger the
group (some number in the millions), the more stable the immediate energy
environment becomes. This is an important discovery because it explains the vast
differences encountered when exploring the nonphysical dimensions. For example,
the first nonphysical dimension is a parallel energy world almost identical to the
physical universe. This dimension of energy existing close to the physical is molded
by the consensus thoughts of the six billion inhabitants existing in the physical.
The underlying cause of this phenomenon appears to be remarkable: consciousness
creates reality. All reality, including matter, is shaped and molded by thought.
Creation itself is the result of conscious thought-energy influencing, arranging, and
manifesting form and substance as we know it. Countless nonphysical explorations
into the interior of universe confirm this observation. It’s only the density of matter
that obscures the truth of this from our physical senses. In the physical world,
consciousness uses biological vehicles for its expression. Our physical bodies are
the direct tools of our consciousness; our thoughts direct our bodies to build the
reality we experience every day of our lives. This process of consciousness creating
reality is more important than words can begin to express. Our recognition of this
reality is the first step to true mastery of ourselves and our surroundings. Each of
us possesses the creative ability and power to shape and mold his or her ideal
physical, emotional, and intellectual surroundings. It is up to us, however, to
recognize and implement our creative ability. Our recognition of the creative power
of consciousness will dramatically affect both our immediate future and the
evolution of our species. Until we truly comprehend and consciously control the
unseen energies flowing through us, we will be bound to the dense molecular forms
that surround us. Our evolution from a physical creature to a multidimensional,
nonphysical being is directly linked to the recognition and conscious control of our
thought-energy. Once we truly comprehend our individual ability to shape and mold
the energy around us, we can begin to take full responsibility for our thoughts. With
every thought and deed we become aware that we are the creative artists of our
lives.
The truth of this becomes apparent during an out-of-body experience. When out-ofbody
we are experiencing and exploring a higher-frequency environment, one that
is significantly less dense than matter. This subtle energy environment is sensitive
to thought. Each focused thought can and will create an immediate result: if we
think of flying, we will fly; if we think of walking through a wall, we do so. Our
thoughts exert complete control over our experience. For the first time, the true
creative power of thought becomes clear. This realization is a major step in our
personal evolution, for now we know that we must take full responsibility for our
thoughts and our life. The concept of consciousness creating or molding reality is
not as far-fetched as some may believe. Many of the finest minds of modern
physics consider this theory the logical basis of all reality. The eminent physicist
David Bohm, Princeton physicist Eugene Wigner, Berkeley physicist Henry Pierce
Stapp, and legendary physicists Walter Heirler, Fritz London, and John von
Neumann are all supporters of the “consciousness creates reality” quantum theory.
In increasing numbers, physicists and mathematicians around the world are
arriving at the same conclusion: physical objects would have no attributes if a
conscious observer were not watching them. Nobel laureate Eugene Wigner
summed up this observation when he stated, “It is not possible to formulate the
laws of quantum mechanics in a fully consistent way without reference to the
consciousness, . . . It will remain remarkable in whatever way our future concepts
may develop, that the very study of the external world led to the conclusion that
the content of the consciousness is an ultimate reality.”
As my nonphysical explorations continued, I came to realize that I was observing
and interacting within a parallel energy dimension. My concepts of space, time, and
distance no longer seemed valid. I began to recognize that the dimension I was
exploring when out-of-body was extremely close to the physical; in fact, it was not
separated at all by space or distance, but rather by energy frequency or density. As
strange as it may sound, the other dimensions (possibly countless numbers of
them) exist with us now. In addition, I observed that each physical object
possessed a nonphysical counterpart or energy duplicate that appeared similar to
an energy mold. For example, the closest nonphysical dimension and its energy
structures coexist with the physical dimension and function as a form of energy
substructure for matter itself. However, the same nonphysical structures also exist
completely independent of the physical universe. The immediate nonphysical
environments I encountered appeared to be physical-like representations of matter.
These nonphysical objects, though stable in structure and quite similar to matter,
were often not an exact duplicate of my physical surroundings. At first this was
confusing, but slowly I learned that it was my expectation of reality that often
needed reappraisal.
I made several startling observations. First, we assume that our physical
surroundings are the stable and firm basis of reality. We view density and form as
the ultimate test of “real.” But what if we are wrong in our assumptions? What if
reality is completely relative to the vibratory rate of the observer? What if there are
numerous, even countless, energy dimensions? Second, after repeatedly exploring
the immediate nonphysical environment, I began to question whether the physical
world is a duplicate of the nonphysical or vice versa. This observation is important
because it points to the fundamental structure of all energy, matter, and reality as
we know it. At first I assumed that the parallel nonphysical dimension was the
result of matter. But with experience I have come to recognize that this is not so.
The parallel universe is indeed a separate energy-universe that functions as the
unseen substructure of all physical energy form and substance. The nonphysical
and the physical are inseparable elements of the same. Third, I gradually began to
understand that I was actually observing a continuum of energy. Each physical
object we observe around us exists in multiple dimensions of the universe. As
startling as it seemed, the end result was clear: all physical objects, including all
life-forms, are multidimensional in nature. Everything we see around us exists as a
continuum of energy. Matter is not the center of reality as we view it. Instead,
matter appears to be the end result of a series of energy interactions occurring in
the unseen dimensions. With each out-of-body experience I realized more clearly
that matter is only a tiny portion of the energy environments that exist. In many
respects, matter is the dense outermost result of a magnificent chain of events
occurring just beyond our physical vision.
It appears that our perception of matter, the visible universe, and our place in the
universe is completely inaccurate. The universe we see around us is not the center
of reality; it is only the outer crust, the thin epidermis layer of the unseen universe.
In time, I was further convinced that everything we believe is solid and real is only
a temporary vehicle of consciousness. This solid reality around us only appears real
to us because we are currently focusing on our physical senses. Once we separate
from our biological body, the world of matter looks like a world of ghosts, a world of
hazy, ethereal forms.
With each out-of-body experience, I’ve observed that the solid physical objects
around me appear as vaporous forms. In several instances, physical objects such
as walls and furniture appeared like holographic images possessing a defined but
vaporous substance. When I tried to touch these objects, my hand just passed
through them. Often, I felt a tingling sensation as my hand or body moved through
the physical objects, but the objects didn’t seem real anymore in relationship to my
new vibratory rate. In addition, I noticed that the longer I remained separated from
my body, the more my immediate physical surroundings seemed to fade from my
view. It became obvious that the only reality to me was the objects or beings that
were vibrating close to my new personal frequency rate. In other words, reality is
relative to the vibrational density of the observer.
At first glance, this observation may sound strange; however, modern physics has
provided some evidence that helps explain it. For example, scientists have shown
that visible light exists simultaneously as a particle and a wave. The dual nature of
light is now a recognized fact of modern science. I believe the particle-wave nature
of light provides substantial evidence that all energy is a multifrequency
(dimensional) continuum extending far beyond the dense particles of matter that
we observe around us. Just as light possesses a dual nature, both particle and
wave, so all physical objects and life-forms consist of both physical particles and
nonphysical energy components. It is this interconnected continuum of energy that
creates and sustains the entire multidimensional universe. Every physical object
around us is actually the dense outer result of this continuum of energy. Just as
light exists as both a particle and a wave at the same instant in time, so all physical
objects exist simultaneously as dense molecular forms and nonphysical-spiritual
forms. This realization opens the door to a remarkable new frontier of exploration
and research.
Part 2 - Solving Our Greatest Mysteries
CHAPTER 3
The New Frontier
The worldwide scientific community now agrees that an unseen energy structure must
exist.
—David Seckel,
Cosmologist, University of California
In the last few decades science has become aware of the serious limitations of
human visual perception. The human eye is sensitive to only a narrow band of
radiation. We see only the wavelength between .00007 cm. and .00004 cm.; the
rest of the electromagnetic wave spectrum remains invisible to us. In fact, only a
few one-hundred-thousandths of a centimeter make the difference between
visibility and invisibility. Yet all of us are literally swimming in a sea of energy,
immersed in an ocean of electromagnetic waves: gamma rays, X rays, ultraviolet
and infrared rays, microwaves, radio waves, and shortwaves, to name just a few.
When we feel the heat of the sun, for example, we are feeling the result of invisible
infrared rays; their wavelength, .00008 cm. to .032 cm., is a little too long for our
retina to detect even though our skin will register the rays as heat.
Electromagnetic Wave Spectrum
Wavelength (in centimeters)
1 Unknown 8 Heat waves
2 Cosmic rays 9 Radar
3 Gamma rays 10 Television
4 X-rays 11 Short radio waves
5 Ultraviolet 12 Broadcast waves
6 Visible light 13 Long radio waves
7 Infrared 14 Unknown
In effect, our perception of the universe is based upon only a tiny fraction of the
energy around us. Even more shocking is the recognition that our current scientific
technology detects only a portion of the entire energy spectrum. Most scientists
believe that the electromagnetic wave spectrum continues far beyond our
technological vision and possibly into infinity. When we put this into perspective, we
recognize that each of us is visually aware of only three-onehundred-thousandths
(.00003) of a centimeter of the energy radiation around us. We, who see so little of
the universe, are quick to reach conclusions and judgments based upon the narrow
limits of our vision. Our perspective of the universe, and of reality itself, is severely
limited by the narrow range of our physical senses.
When we look around, we see a world of solid objects. On the surface, reality
appears to consist of three-dimensional form and substance. Yet, as science
explores deeper into the unseen heart of matter, remarkable discoveries are being
made. Einstein’s famous equation E = MC2 tells us that matter is nothing more
than a form of energy—in a sense, stored energy temporarily molded to construct
the physical objects around us.
Once we recognize that all matter is actually energy, we can begin to form a new
vision of ourselves and the world around us. We begin to realize that our
surroundings are not what they seem. This new vision is expanded even further
when we examine the latest discoveries of quantum physics. Quantum theorists no
longer consider energy to be particle-like in nature. Subatomic particles are no
longer viewed as static things but as four-dimensional entities in space-time. In
fact, the elemental particles of our reality (quarks and so on) are no longer
considered substance at all. When physicists observe elemental particles, they
describe them as dynamic patterns, constantly moving and changing into one
another. Quantum mechanics has shown us that the elemental building blocks of
our reality are not material but are patterns of energy interconnected to form an
inseparable cosmic web.
Quantum physics has proved that our current physical concepts of form and
substance are obsolete; not only is matter energy, but all energy is essentially
nonphysical in nature. Physicist Werner Heisenberg clarified this new scientific
viewpoint when he stated, “Atoms are not things.” After decades of remarkable
discoveries, modern physics has reached an impasse. The observed motion of
subatomic particles appears to follow little or no logical order. Elemental particles
change their location and trajectory, appear and disappear, and move in all sorts of
mysterious ways. Even more startling is the realization that they can actually be
influenced by the thoughts of the scientists who are observing them.
As a new century dawns, the greatest mysteries of science remain unsolved. What
are matter and energy? What are the unseen building blocks of physical reality?
Increasingly, physicists and astronomers worldwide are recognizing that an
immense unseen energy system must exist just beyond our technological vision.
Years ago a few astronomers observed that specific areas in space existed with
insufficient mass to explain their motion. In the 1980s this mysterious condition
was termed “dark matter.” The discovery of dark matter was first brought to light
by the extensive research of astronomer Vera Rubin. In The Astronomers Donald
Goldsmith outlines her work and its significance. By analyzing the motions of
outlying stars, Rubin’s observations revealed enormous quantities of invisible
matter in spiral galaxies such as our own Milky Way. Studies of the motions of
galaxies in clusters, performed by other astronomers (and some by Rubin herself),
showed that the clusters of galaxies likewise contain tremendous amounts of
invisible matter.
Indeed, even before Rubin’s work, astronomers had found that most large galaxy
clusters appear to contain far more mass than can be explained by the stars that
shine in their galaxies. But it took Rubin’s detailed studies of the motions of stars
within our own and other galaxies to convince astronomers that nearly every
galaxy, and not just those in large galaxy clusters, has far more mass in invisible
form than in stars. In short, Rubin’s work established the existence of a previously
unconfirmed component of the cosmos, a component that is no small addition to
what we know but (broadly speaking) the universe itself.
Everything we see—all the stars, star clusters, star-forming regions, and gas clouds
lit by newborn stars—apparently amounts to no more than 10 percent of the total
mass of a large galaxy such as our own Milky Way. Hence Rubin’s research implies
that all the visible matter in the universe forms only a sort of light frosting on the
cosmic cake, which consists basically of invisible matter. The discovery of dark
matter (invisible mass) provides evidence of an unseen substructure to the
universe.
In the last two decades physicists and astronomers worldwide have arrived at the
same conclusion: something unseen is interacting with matter. In 1981 the eminent
theoretical physicist David Bohm proposed that the substructure of the subatomic
makes sense only if we assume the existence of additional, more complex
dimensions beyond our vision. This concept is growing in popularity. Many of the
greatest scientific minds of the twentieth century have commented that something
mysterious is occurring just beyond our technological vision. Einstein, Heisenberg,
Planck, Pauli, Schrodinger, Jeans, Eddington, Bohr, and de Broglie have all
expressed a belief that physics and mysticism are somehow connected. Sir James
Jeans may have summed up this belief when he stated, “The universe begins to
look more like a great thought than a great machine.”
The Multidimensional Structure of the Universe
When we examine the evolution of science over the last few decades, we see a
growing body of evidence supporting the multidimensional structure of matter and
the universe. The latest discoveries of quantum physics provide numerous
examples. Also significant is the growing number of physicists, astrophysicists, and
astronomers who believe in the existence of parallel universes. Well-known
physicist Fred Alan Wolf summarized this view when he stated, “By including
quantum physics, we find strong and surprising evidence for the existence of
parallel universes at the very beginning of time.”
The Concept of Parallel Universes
The idea of parallel universes or dimensions is not new. Einstein’s theory of
relativity first predicted the existence of four-dimensional space-time and black
holes. It was not until 1935, however, that Einstein and his Princeton University
associate Nathan Rosen presented their new theory concerning the function of black
holes. They proposed that instead of being a simple hole or rift in space-time, as
was first believed, a black hole was actually a bridge connecting one universe to
another possible universe. Einstein and Rosen stated that black holes were
“bridges” to anywhere and any time. In physics today this concept is known as the
Einstein-Rosen Bridge.
The Einstein-Rosen Bridge was the first widely accepted scientific theory concerning
the possible existence of parallel universes or dimensions. Einstein and Rosen’s
work set the stage for following generations of physicists to seriously study the
concept of parallel universes. For example, the “many worlds interpretation”
presented in 1951 by physicist Hugh Everett III was heavily influenced by the
earlier work of Einstein and Rosen. Everett’s theory states that many worlds or
universes coexist with our own; however, they are continuously splitting into
separate, distinct dimensions that are mutually inaccessible. According to Everett,
each world or dimension contains a different version of the same people living their
lives and performing various acts at the same moment- in time. This theory,
though highly controversial, has become well known in modern physics and is
considered by some to provide a possible explanation of quantum reality.
Over the last sixty years the concept of parallel energy-universes and their
interconnecting bridges has been developed by a number of wellknown
physicists, including Arthur Eddington, Christian Fronsdal, David Finkelstein, John
Wheeler, G, Szertes, and Charles Misner. But it was another physicist, Princeton’s
Martin Kruskal, who first developed a written concept of it. In 1961 Kruskal
presented his black hole map showing an interconnection between our physical
universe and another, unseen universe.
In 1963 Australian physicist and mathematician Roy P. Kerr developed precise
equations relating to the rotation of black holes. Kerr’s equations indicated the
existence of an infinite number of parallel universes, all directly connecting to black
holes. He proposed that an infinite series or patchwork of universes extends toward
the past and toward the future simultaneously. As strange as the concept may
sound, Kerr’s work is highly regarded by physicists around the world. Many
consider his equations to have been one of the most important developments in
theoretical astrophysics in the mid-twentieth century.
In addition, H. Reissner in Germany and G. Nordstrom in Denmark formulated a
scenario of black holes connecting to other universes. Because of their work, an
electrically charged black hole is sometimes called a “Reissner-Nordstrom black
hole.”
I believe that the existence of black holes, the Einstein-Rosen Bridge, and the
equations, maps, and theories of Everett, Kruskal, Kerr, and Reissner and
Nordstrom are all evidence of the multidimensional nature and structure of the
universe. This growing body of evidence compiled by physicists and astronomers
around the world points to the most important discovery of the twentieth century:
our universe is a multidimensional continuum of interconnected energy.
Historical Evidence Supporting the Multidimensional Universe
When we look at history, we see that the idea of heaven or nonphysical universes is
one of the oldest and most widely held beliefs of humanity. The concept of heaven
appears in every culture and religion. The Jewish and Christian religions teach the
existence of three universes or dimensions: the physical world, heaven, and hell.
Catholicism added a fourth with the concept of purgatory. In the Koran, Mohammed
speaks of seven heavens or universes.
In more recent times the theosophy view developed by Madame Blavatsky
described seven dimensions. This concept of seven dimensions is also incorporated
into various New Age philosophies. When we examine religions and cultures around
the world, the concept of unseen heavens or universes of energy is without a doubt
the most universal belief of humanity. Today practically every religion and culture
has incorporated this concept. Even though this is likely the most widely held
theory in human history, verifiable evidence concerning the unseen heavens
continues to elude humankind. As you will discover, out-of-body exploration
provides powerful personal verification that the religious “heavens” described in the
scriptures of your religion actually do exist. Firsthand explorations have proved that
the biblical heavens are in reality the magnificent unseen energy environments that
make up the multidimensional universe.
Energy Tunnels
Additional evidence of the belief in nonphysical
universes and connecting energy tunnels has
been displayed in the literature and artwork of
various cultures for the past two thousand years.
For example, artists for centuries have portrayed
tunnels of energy leading to a radiant new
environment or heaven.
Dutch painter Hieronymus Bosch (1460—1516),
in his well-known work “The Ascent into the
Empyrean”, clearly illustrates an individual being
escorted through an energy tunnel. At the end of
the tunnel is a bright light indicating heaven (a
higher-frequency dimension).
Two centuries later William Blake (1757—1827), the English poet, mystic, and
painter, created his masterpiece titled “Jacob’s Ladder”. In his striking watercolor
he portrays human beings and angels moving both upward and downward toward a
brilliant circle or tunnel of light.
William Blake “Jacob’s Ladder”
Later in the nineteenth century Gustave Dore (1832—1883) created his famous
engraving of Dante and Beatrice as they experience the beatific vision. In graphic
detail he portrays a nonphysical tunnel leading to a light.
Gustave Dore “The Empyrean”
I believe a startling connection is apparent: the energy tunnels depicted by Bosch,
Blake, Dore, Einstein, and Rosen and the energy conduits outlined in this book are
all descriptions of the same event—an energy tunnel connecting the physical
dimension with a nonphysical counterpart. Additional evidence for this belief is
provided by millions of near-death experiences reported worldwide in the last
twenty years. One of the most fascinating aspects -of the near-death accounts is
their vivid description of a tunnel leading toward a bright light or a new
environment. According to extensive studies conducted by Raymond Moody, Melvin
Morse, Kenneth Ring, and other physicians, this description of an energy tunnel
leading to a bright light is reported in every culture and country of the world. Notice
the similarity between the Einstein-Rosen Bridge (see illustration above) and the
observations made by countless people who have had a near-death experience.
Observations obtained during controlled out-of-body explorations suggest that the
tunnel of light is the opening of the nonphysical energy membrane separating the
physical dimension from its parallel nonphysical neighbor. The energy tunnel
commonly observed during a near-death experience is actually a highly organized
temporary opening or rift in the nonphysical energy membrane and appears to
open automatically to allow life-forms to pass through. After the life-form
(consciousness) passes within the higher-frequency energy dimension, the tunnel
opening immediately returns to its original shape and form.
The tunnel experience is much more significant than most people recognize. Not
only does it provide substantial evidence of a logical transitional method for
consciousness after physical death, but it directly relates to the modern physics
theories concerning parallel universes and energy wormholes, as well as to my
observations concerning the multidimensional universe. The time has come for
modern science to investigate this reality. Millions of near-death and out-of-body
experiences occurring in every culture and society of the world cannot be a
coincidence. In addition, the countless reports of energy tunnels reaching back five
hundred years can no longer be overlooked. The scientific investigation of the
parallel nonphysical energy dimensions and their tunnel openings will be a major
step forward in modern science, for it will light the way to a true comprehension of
our multidimensional universe.
A Remarkable New View of the Universe
As scientists continue to focus on external matter, another group of people have
fearlessly explored the very heart of the universe. Bypassing the traditional
scientific methods, they have ventured far beyond the limits of our current
technological evolution and expanded human explorations into undiscovered areas
of the universe. This has been achieved by incorporating a revolutionary new form
of investigation: self-controlled nonphysical explorations into the unseen
substructure of the universe. The discoveries made during these nonphysical
explorations provide revolutionary new insights into the unseen structure of the
universe, our existence, and our continuation after death.
Based on out-of-body observations, all energy dimensions exist here and now. The
seen and unseen universe is a continuum of energy frequencies. Each dimension
exists independently according to its individual frequency, yet they are all linked by
the flow of nonphysical energy. Each dimension of energy is interconnected with its
energy neighbors to form a complete system—the multidimensional universe. The
eminent physicist David Bohm was absolutely correct when he observed that
“Reality is an undivided whole.” The entire multidimensional (frequency) universe is
an inseparable whole; there exists no spatial or temporal separation. Bohm was
decades ahead of his time when he said, “One is led to a new notion of unbroken
wholeness which denies the classical analyzability of the world into separately and
independently existing parts. . . . The inseparable quantum interconnectedness of
the whole universe is a fundamental reality.” Forget all your spatial concepts of up
and down, near and far. The entire multidimensional universe is here and now. The
closest physical concept that describes the structure of the universe is degree of
density. Each dimension encountered after we shed the physical body is
progressively less dense in its vibrational substance. In effect, the universe can be
compared with an energy wave spectrum of incomparable depth and beauty. Each
frequency of the energy spectrum is experienced and observed by us as a separate
and distinct dimension, yet all are interconnected to form a magnificent universe
extending beyond space, form, and substance as we perceive it.
Out-of-body explorations provide startling new evidence that the universe is a
multidimensional continuum of energy emanating from a nonphysical source; the
physical galaxies we observe around us are merely the dense molecular crust of the
complete universe. Comprehending the existence of this multidimensional universe
is difficult because our current perceptions of space-time and reality offer
inaccurate reference points.
All the energy dimensions exist simultaneously within the same space-time
continuum. For example, when I’m out-of-body I can occupy the same space as a
physical wall or ceiling. I’m not separated from the physical wall by distance but
rather by my individual energy frequency. This recognition leads us to an exciting
new adventure.
Our universe is not what it appears to be. Visible stars, dust, gas clouds, and cosmic debris
make up less than 10 percent of the mass that scientists know is present. Astronomers,
astrophysicists, and physicists are currently hard at work searching for the unseen energy
that supports our galaxy and our physical universe.
Charting the Unseen Universe
As traditional science continues to focus upon the dense epidermis layer of the
universe, the exploration and charting of the unseen dimensions have quietly
begun. Through extensive trial and error, a few individuals have taken the leap
beyond matter and the limits of our current physical technology. The observations
made during these nonphysical explorations shed light on a multidimensional
universe of incredible depth and beauty. If we are to comprehend the structure of
the unseen dimensions, we must constantly consider the natural thoughtresponsiveness
of the subtle nonphysical energy environments, beyond the parallel
(first) nonphysical dimension, we are exploring an interactive, thought-responsive
universe of energy. Once we recognize the energy interplay between thought and
nonphysical energy, however, we can begin to focus on the specific energy
similarities inherent in a given vibrational level or area. This is best accomplished
by classifying the way a specific nonphysical environment responds to focused
thought-energy. This kind of energy classification is far more practical than
concentrating on the visual appearances and differences between dimensions. Two
different and distinct vibrational dimensions can appear surprisingly alike even
though their vibrational frequencies may be completely different. This is why
traditional physical concepts are inadequate to judge nonphysical environments. To
effectively chart the unseen universe, we must create a new baseline or method of
comparison. The most practical method to achieve this is to classify the thoughtresponsiveness
of a given nonphysical area.
The vast majority of nonphysical environments encountered are extremely thoughtresponsive.
In other words, when we separate from our bodies and enter a
nonphysical dimension, our thoughts, both conscious and subconscious, will
immediately begin to interact with and restructure the subtle energy around us.
The thought-responsiveness of the inner dimensions explains why out-of-body
explorers often describe the environments they witness with such diversity.
Complicating this situation is the fact that countless environments and realities
exist within each individual dimension of the universe. Even though there is an
unlimited variety of possible environments within the universe, all the nonphysical
environments and dimensions appear to have certain similarities and differences.
Each dimension and environment consists of specific frequencies or wavelengths of
nonphysical energy. In addition, each nonphysical dimension and environment
appears to be the direct result of thought. The natural thought-responsiveness of
the inner dimensions has created much of the confusion and mystery surrounding
the inner environments. We have a natural tendency to relate nonphysical
experiences directly to physical reference points—we compare everything to
physical objects with which we are familiar. In effect, the molecular forms around
us are not a valid baseline of reality. Physical objects and events are not the center
of the universe, as many assume, but the end result of a chain of unseen energy
reactions occurring deep within the unseen interior of the multidimensional
universe.
The universe is a continuum of energy frequencies emanating from a nonphysical source.
The physical universe we observe is the molecular epidermis layer of the complete
multidimensional universe. All energy dimensions exist within the same time-space as the
visible universe.
To comprehend the nature of the universe, we must reappraise our current
concepts of substance, energy, and time. We must be open-minded to a new
viewpoint of reality. To truly understand the underlying structure of our universe,
we must investigate the unseen cause of form and substance. I believe the
overwhelming power of out-of-body exploration is our ability to do just that.
Information concerning the nonphysical dimensions is more valuable than most of
us recognize. Not only can it help us to adapt and adjust within nonphysical
environments, but it can also dramatically affect our current physical existence.
Up to now the vast majority of humanity has died without prior knowledge of its
destination. Death has remained a dark void; we hope and pray for good things,
but most of us approach the transition of death in absolute ignorance of our final
destination. Up to now humankind has lacked firsthand, verifiable information about
the mystery of life after death and the nonphysical environments that are
experienced. Controlled out-of-body experiences change all this. By pursuing
nonphysical exploration, we can experience the many possible environments that
will be our future home. In a very real sense we can scout ahead and become
familiar with our nonphysical homeland.
Types of Energy Environments
A single nonphysical dimension can (and often does) contain three primary types of
energy environments: consensus, nonconsensus, and natural. A consensus
environment is any environment or reality that is created and maintained by the
thoughts of a group of individuals. For example, the heavens of each religious
group are created by the thoughts and beliefs of their respective inhabitants. Like
all realities, the consensus environments are molded by the group consciousness.
Many of the consensus environments are extremely old and resistant to change. As
unusual as it may sound, physical cities and communities are examples of
consensus energy environments. Every city and town is created and developed
according to the thoughts of its inhabitants. Essentially, human thought-energy
uses biological vehicles to manipulate and mold the physical molecules around us.
The end result is the temporary physical structures we see.
During an out-of-body or near-death experience, we transfer our conscious
awareness from our physical body to our higher-frequency nonphysical body. For
the sake of clarity I refer to this as "moving inward.” I use the term movement
because this energy transition is often experienced as a sensation of inner motion.
Any reference to inner movement or inner exploration relates to the conscious
recognition of a higherfrequency energy area of the universe.
As we explore inward away from matter, we discover that the first nonphysical
dimension parallels the physical universe and is also a consensus reality. This
energy environment is so physical in appearance that most people believe they are
observing the physical world. In reality, they are observing the first inner energy
dimension of the universe. Since this dimension is closest in frequency to matter, it
is often seen and experienced during out-of-body explorations. This dimension is a
classic example of a consensus reality: its structure is solid and stable within its
own vibratory frequency. Our thoughts, no matter how focused, have little effect on
the energy structures within this environment. However, our thoughts will exert a
tremendous impact upon our personal energy-body. Thoughts of flying will enable
us to fly. Thoughts of walking will enable us to walk. The distinction between
external and internal (personal) energy changes is critical to understanding the
inherent structure of a nonphysical dimension or environment. In a consensus
environment, our thoughts influence our personal energy but not the energy
surrounding us. The various heavens referred to by Saint John in Revelation and
Mohammed in the Koran are classic examples of consensus environments. These
nonphysical cities and structures exist within the second and third energy
dimensions and continue to be molded and maintained by the group consciousness
of millions of nonphysical inhabitants. When we enter these environments, our
thoughts will not change the structures encountered.
A nonconsensus environment is any nonphysical environment or reality that is not
firmly molded by a group. I have found that this type of environment is the most
prevalent. The appearance can be anything we imagine: a forest, a park, a city, an
ocean, even an entire planet. Nonconsensus environments are easily detected
because, while often physical-like in appearance, they are extremely sensitive to
focused thoughts and will rapidly change and restructure according to the prevailing
conscious and subconscious thoughts present in the immediate area. If you find
yourself in an environment that changes often or seems to be unstable, you are
more than likely in a nonconsensus reality. If this is the case, then it is important
for you to know that your thoughts, both conscious and subconscious, have
probably influenced the reality you are experiencing. Nonconsensus areas are often
molded by our subconscious mind for our benefit. For example, if you are
experiencing a recurring problem or block in your personal development, your
subconscious mind or higher self may mold an environment and situation that allow
you to confront this block on a very personal basis. You could face a representation
of your fears in the form of a crashing plane or car, or confront a personal limitation
or self-concept. This personal confrontation can take any shape or form that will
effectively assist us in experiencing and overcoming our limits, barriers, or fears.
Many people report themselves projected into a situation that tested or tempered
them in a very personal way—often through confronting their greatest fears and
limits.
For example, if you are deathly afraid of heights, you could experience yourself
climbing a mountain or crossing a narrow bridge. A good example of this is detailed
by Robert Monroe in Journeys Out-of the-Body, where he describes repeated
attempts to land a small plane on the top of a building while he is out-of-body.
More often, the nonconsensus environments will appear much like our normal or
even idyllic physical surroundings; parks, landscaped country gardens, and peaceful
green meadows are commonly reported. I believe it’s probable that many of these
areas were created by the thoughts of other nonphysical life-forms who have
inhabited or explored the areas in the past. Unlike in the physical world, once an
energy environment is formed, it can last for centuries. Cellular and molecular
decay are not an issue; it’s simply a matter of thought-energy formation and
stability. A single, firmly held, creative thought can mold an energy environment
capable of lasting almost indefinitely; however, a stronger (more focused) thought
could alter the entire environment within seconds. Remember that all environments
are a form of energy, and all energy is thought-responsive to some degree. Natural
(raw) energy environments are completely unformed areas of the universe that
appear without a specific shape or form of any kind. These areas are often
observed as misty voids, empty space, or featureless, open areas consisting of
white, silver, or golden clouds of energy. Natural energy environments are
extremely sensitive to thought. Any focused thought will instantly mold the
immediate energy environment. This is why it is so important to gain some degree
of control over our thoughts. Our personal evolution largely depends on the way we
focus, control, and direct our thought-energy.
No matter what dimension we inhabit, our personal responsibility for our thoughts
and actions is absolute. All thoughts are creative; both positive and negative
thoughts and action will create a corresponding restructuring of the immediate
nonphysical environment. This is why spiritual leaders have always stressed themes
of “do unto others” and “love for all.” Once you fully recognize the power of your
thoughts, you will never again create or hold a negative or destructive image in
your mind. Negative and self-limiting thoughts are the real enemy we must face.
Within the inner dimensions of the universe, our thoughts, both good and bad,
exert a powerful creative influence upon our immediate environment. This is readily
observed and experienced during an out-of-body experience. In addition to the
three most prevalent types of environments encountered when out-of-body, there
are two others. The first, though rarely observed and reported, seems to consist of
dimensions and environments that exist beyond thought-energy. Currently, few
explorers have consciously ventured far enough within the universe to provide an
accurate description or model of these dimensions. Possessing no perceivable shape
or structure, these areas of the universe are postulated to exist beyond space,
time, and energy as we conceive of them. It is possible that these dimensions and
their inhabitants are indescribable by our linear concepts. Even so, I’m certain that
non-thought and non-form energy environments exist deep within the interior of
the universe.
The other observed environment is an area that appears to be a duplicate of empty
space. This is an extremely low energy environment. Some believe that nonphysical
space is a consensus environment. I seriously doubt this theory because no
perceivable energy radiations or vibrations are emitted from empty space itself. All
noticeable energy emanations appear to be located near inhabited locations. I think
it is more likely that “empty” space lacks sufficient local energy to be affected by
thought; as a result, it remains in a relatively constant state. It should also be
noted that empty nonphysical space appears to become increasingly prevalent as
we explore inward away from the physical dimension and toward the source of all
energy. The reason for this is unknown. The observations of numerous nonphysical
explorers will be required before we can arrive at a conclusion.
The multidimensional universe is not just another theory; it is an observable fact.
By implementing the out-of-body techniques presented in this book, you can verify
this discovery for yourself. Self-initiated and controlled out-of-body experiences
give us a remarkable opportunity to explore deep within the unseen interior of the
universe. The current scientific focus on dense molecular activity will slowly shift to
a frequency-based form of research. In the twenty-first century, science will begin
to recognize that the dense forms around us are the outer vehicles of energy and
that the entire physical universe is only a tiny portion of the magnificent
multidimensional universe.
Solving Our Greatest Mysteries
Nonphysical exploration into the unseen substructure of the universe provides new
insights into many mysteries of science and religion. The following are a few
examples.
PSYCHIC PHENOMENA
The multidimensional nature of the universe logically explains the existence of
present-day mysteries such as extrasensory perception, telepathy, precognition,
channeling, psychokinesis, apparitions, and faith healing. In fact, all psychic and
spiritual phenomena are the direct result of the subtle energy interactions between
the physical dimension and its parallel energy counterpart. For example,
apparitions and poltergeist activity are simply the natural result of a nonphysical
inhabitant lowering its per sonal vibrational frequency (density) so that it can
temporarily be seen or interact within the denser physical dimension. This and all
“paranormal” events are quite normal and to be expected in a multidimensional
universe.
SPACE-TIME CURVATURE
According to Einstein’s theory of relativity, the curvature of space is directly related
to matter. In effect, space curves around massive celestial objects such as stars. To
visualize this, you might think of a lead ball placed upon a tightly fitted bedsheet.
The sheet (space) will curve to accommodate the ball. After decades of intense
scrutiny, Einstein’s theory has been validated mathematically by some of the
brightest minds of modern physics. Still, the curvature of space remains a
perplexing mystery. I believe the mystery can be solved if we explore deeper into
the unseen core of the universe. According to numerous out-of-body explorers, the
direct energy substructure of the physical universe is a parallel dimension of subtle
nonphysical energy. The outer physical dimension we observe around us is
separated from its energy neighbor by an unseen membrane of energy. This
membrane is often observed during near-death experiences and is reported to form
a temporary tunnel-like opening allowing the individual to enter the next energy
dimension.
Based on extensive nonphysical observations, I contend that the curvature of space
is the direct result of the curvature of the supporting nonphysical energy
membranes and dimensions that support the visible universe. The outer physical
dimension (the visible universe) actually conforms to the shape of the unseen
energy membrane. This nonphysical energy membrane acts as an internal cell wall,
providing the support and substructure necessary for the existence of an external
physical universe (dimension). Because the inner energy membrane is remarkably
stable and flexible in its form, it appears likely that the energy membrane provides
the necessary support required by all physical celestial bodies.
ENERGY MEMBRANES
The unseen substructure and support for the visible universe are provided by a
series of unseen, nonphysical energy membranes. The outermost (densest) energy
membrane exists parallel with the physical universe. The energy membranes occur
at interdimensional convergence points and serve as energy buffers. Similar in
function to biological cell walls, they separate different frequencies of energy from
one another. For example, the first inner energy membrane separates the outer
physical dimension from its parallel but unseen energy neighbor.
Embedding of an uncollapsed spherical star.
The embedded surface shows the curvature of space around the star. All points
outside the embedded surface are without physical significance. Each circle traced
an the surface represents the set of points situated at the same distance from the
center of the star, while the orthogonal curves pass through the bottom of the
hollow that is the center of the star. At great distances from the star, the
gravitational field is weak and the embedding surface loses its curvature. However,
it does not become a horizontal plane as the illustration suggests, but rather a
paraboloid. Near the star, the curvature is more accentuated. The shaded area
indicates the region effectively occupied by the star. (Adapted from the original.)
All energy membranes are structured, yet extremely flexible in form and substance.
When pierced or entered, they commonly take the form of an opening or tunnel
large enough to accommodate the entering object. This tunnel effect is a temporary
phenomenon. The membranes quickly return to their normal shape after an object
or life-form has passed completely through them. This temporary tunnel effect has
been observed and reported by millions of people who have had near-death
experiences. Each energy membrane provides the underlying support, stability, and
substructure necessary for its energy neighbor. For example, the first membrane
provides the energy support system for the physical universe. It’s the invisible,
internal cell wall that supports the physical universe. This unseen energy
membrane and its containing energy constitute the “dark matter” theorized by
astronomers and physicists. Each membrane provides a highly organized and
structured system for energy transfer between the higherfrequency (less dense)
energy dimension and its denser counterparts. In a sense, each membrane acts as
an energy filter. Nonphysical energy can flow from the internal areas of the
universe toward the external; however, the denser atomic and molecular forms
cannot move inwardly without a dramatic change in their frequency rate (death).
The energy membranes provide the unseen inner support for the entire
multidimensional universe. The external physical universe and its galaxies simply
could not exist without this essential energy support system.
THE EXPANDING UNIVERSE
In 1929 Edwin Hubble shocked the world’s scientific community with the most
important discovery in modern astronomy. He provided conclusive evidence that
the universe, until then considered a static and stable environment, is actually
expanding in size. Hubble proved not only that the universe is expanding but that
distant galaxies are traveling away from us at even greater speeds than the
galaxies near us. Hubble’s discoveries continue to perplex scientists. Over the last
few decades many theories have been presented to explain this incredible
expansion of our universe. Today astronomers, astrophysicists, and theoretical
physicists have largely accepted the big bang as the logical explanation of this
expansion.
According to the big bang theory, the universe began with a massive explosion
approximately fifteen billion years ago. This explosion created the expansion of
space now observed. It may help clarify the idea of an expanding universe to
visualize the galaxies as dots drawn on a balloon. As the balloon inflates, the
galaxies move apart from one another in all directions. Note that the galaxies
themselves are not flying through space; instead, it is space itself that is
expanding. Today, most scientists assume that the big bang is the cause of the
current expansion of our visible universe. Based on the available scientific data, this
appears to be a logical conclusion. When we explore deeper into the interior of the
universe, however, we discover a far more complex energy system than our
modern physical sciences are aware of.
According to observations obtained when out-of-body, the interior substructure of
the universe (the inner dimensions and their supporting energy membranes) is
expanding in size. This expansion appears to be extremely well controlled and
systematic. Even more important, the expansion of the inner dimensions appears to
be the direct result of an ongoing energy-conversion process that occurs within the
unseen thought-responsive dimensions existing beyond the second nonphysical
dimension. This outward expansion of nonphysical energy and space appears to be
controlled by the external energy conduits (black holes) located throughout the
universe.
Energy expansion begins within the inner dimensions and moves progressively
outward toward the physical universe. The expansion of energy creates the outer
movement of galaxies observed in the universe. The inner membranes provide the
substructure and support for the progressively denser outer dimensions of energy.
The expanding inner membranes provide a stable but flexible energy framework for
the entire multidimensional universe. One thing is certain. Decades of nonphysical
explorations and millions of near-death experiences consistently point to a single
conclusion: the direct substructure of the physical universe is a subtle form of
energy undetectable by our current physical technology. This unseen energy is
highly organized, structured, and supportive of the outer physical universe. The
incredible amount of interdependence existing between the unseen, nonphysical
dimensions and the outer physical crust of the universe points to a much more
complex system of energy than modern technology and science are currently able
to observe.
Even though the underlying cause of the expansion of the multidimensional
universe remains a mystery, it’s now clear that unseen, nonphysical energy
reactions do influence the current physical expansion that we observe. The
big bang theory is a superficial conclusion based on incomplete physical
observations. Indeed, many of our physical-based scientific theories of cosmology,
evolution, and the structure of matter are seriously lacking in vision. This occurs
because current scientific theorems rely entirely upon physical observations and
speculation. A classic example of this shortsightedness is displayed by the longstanding
scientific assumption that consciousness is the direct result of chemical
and electrical reactions occurring in the brain.
When we recognize the multidimensional structure of the universe, we realize that
physical observations alone are inadequate. The galaxies and matter we observe
around us are not the entire universe, as we assume, but only the dense outer
dimension or molecular crust of the complete universe. The volume of the visible
universe amounts to perhaps less than one-tenth of 1 percent of the multidimensional
universe. Clearly, any scientific conclusion or theory based entirely upon
observations of matter is built upon incomplete data. Each new nonphysical
exploration into the interior of the universe substantiates this observation. Ask any
of the millions of people who have had a near-death or out-of-body experience and
they will agree: the universe is far more expansive and complicated than current
physical science can even begin to comprehend or explain. As millions of people
every year have out-of-body and near-death experiences, the reality of the multidimensional
universe and its energy reactions will be recognized as observable fact.
BLACK HOLES
A black hole is an area in space postulated to be so dense that its gravity attracts
all surrounding matter, including light. There are several theories concerning the
existence of black holes. Some scientists believe that they are “bridges” or
“wormholes” to other universes. Others suggest that black holes may be pathways
to the past or future, while still others contend that they collapse into nothingness.
In recent years an impressive list of physicists, mathematicians, and astronomers
have expressed the belief that black holes are interdimensional tunnels leading to
another energy-universe. Kruskal, Szekers, Kerr, Reissner, and Nordstrom have all
created conceptual maps linking black holes to unseen parallel universes. These
black hole theories are not wild speculation, but concepts taken quite seriously by
modern physicists and astronomers.
Based on out-of-body observations, I believe that black holes function as energy
conduits between the physical universe and the inner energy dimensions. These
energy conduits are necessary to balance the energy generated between the inner
energy dimensions and the outer physical universe. In the future, science will be
able to verify that black holes are not a random event of nature but a highly
organized and structured energy-conversion system. This theory will be
scientifically validated when it is discovered that black holes are strategically
located within the center of each galaxy. As the physical universe continues to
expand, there is an increasing need for the external energy forces to be vented and
balanced. Black holes provide the essential energy counterbalance for the
expanding multidimensional universe. I believe that black holes are created by a
massive opening in the inner-dimensional energy membrane. This opening or rift in
the energy membrane creates a corresponding opening within the outer, visible
universe. In the twenty-first century we will discover that black holes are an
integral part of the universal energy-transference system. They not only attract all
particles (including light) in their gravity field but also emit enormous amounts of
energy undetectable by current technology. The unseen energy flowing from the
energy conduits is essential to the overall maintenance, structure, and stability of
the physical galaxies.
THE TUNNELING EFFECT
Physicists discovered years ago that primary particles such as electrons have the
ability to pass through barriers that were considered impenetrable and then
rematerialize on the other side. Based upon the traditional scientific knowledge of
subatomic reality, this should be impossible. Physicist Heinze Pagels of Rockefeller
University refers to this strange rematerialization as “right through the wall.” This
unexplained motion of subatomic particles is now called the tunneling effect. I
believe it’s possible that the observed tunneling effect is the result of elemental
particles moving within the multidimensional universe and then reemerging in a
different area of the physical universe. Since each particle of matter (subatomic or
molecular) already exists as a multidimensional unit of energy, this process of
disappearance is to be expected, not only in physics but also in the realm of human
consciousness. In a very real sense, out-of-body and near-death experiences are a
result of the tunneling effect of consciousness as it moves within the unseen energy
levels of the multidimensional universe and then returns to its physical form. An
unmistakable connection exists between the tunneling effect, parallel universes,
dark matter, black holes, and the curvature of space-time. All five are the direct
result of unseen energy interactions occurring within the interior of the
multidimensional universe. In fact, all subatomic and celestial phenomena are the
result of nonphysical energy waves radiating outward from the unseen interior of
the universe. The entire physical universe is essentially the thin outer molecular
crust of a massive energy continuum created, sustained, and supported by
nonphysical energy waves. Quantum theory, the existence of black holes, the
Einstein-Rosen Bridge, and the particle-wave nature of light all support this
observation.
Quantum Physics and Mysticism
There exists an undeniable relationship between quantum physics and mysticism.
As physics evolves in its recognition of the frequencylike nature of the universe, the
connection will become even more apparent. It’s only logical that first scientists will
research and analyze the latest information presented in recent books on new
physics and near-death and out-of-body experiences. As we absorb and become
comfortable with this extensive body of knowledge, we will slowly begin to extend
our awareness beyond our current physical perceptions.
The step from intellectual curiosity to firsthand experience is the all-important next
step each of us will eventually take. If we ever wish to know the answers, we must
follow in the footsteps of the mystic but maintain the intellectual curiosity of the
physicist.
The connection between new physics and mysticism is presented with great skill in
Fritjof Capra’s The Tao of Physics, Gary Zukav’s The Dancing Wu Li Masters, and
Michael Talbot’s Mysticism and the New Physics. My purpose is to take this
exploration to the next step. Intellectual observations and comparisons are only the
preliminary step in comprehending the true significance of the new physics and the
concepts of mysticism. The books mentioned have set the stage for the next major
evolutionary leap of human consciousness: the movement of human awareness
from the dense molecular vehicles of matter to the conscious exploration of the
nonphysical parallel dimensions of the universe. Without a doubt this is the
evolutionary step toward which all of us are moving. Birth, death, and our current
physical existence are integral elements of our evolutionary journey. Every day we
are closer to leaving our biological vehicle and entering into a new realm of higherfrequency
energy and light. By pursuing the techniques and information presented
in the following chapters, each of us has the opportunity to go beyond intellectual
analysis and experience the truth of this for him- or herself. Not only does
controlled out-of-body exploration expand our vision of the universe; it also
provides insight into new areas.
1. Reality is relative. Experienced reality is relative to the personal energy
frequency of the observer. We experience the energy frequencies closest to our
personal density or vibratory rate.
2. Consciousness is a form of nonphysical energy extending its influence into
matter through the use of biological vehicles.
3. All biological life-forms (including plant and animal life) are temporary cellular
vehicles used by conscious energy (consciousness) for expression in a dense
environment.
4. Our current perception that consciousness is within the physical body is
incorrect. Consciousness exists at a much higher frequency or wavelength than
matter and must interact with biological forms by the use of energy conduits or
vehicles of form. These unseen energy vehicles transfer and step down the higher
frequency of consciousness into the relatively dense physical body.
5. The biological brain is not the origin of consciousness. Instead, it functions as a
temporary biological transfer-and-storage device for consciousness.
6. Consciousness is a continuum of nonphysical energy extending its awareness
through multiple frequencies (dimensions) of the universe.
Evolution of Science
The evolution of our sciences reflects the evolution of human consciousness. When
we examine the progress of physics in the twentieth century, we clearly see the
development from particle (physicalbased) concepts and theories to nonphysical
(frequency-based) observations and discoveries. The progression is especially
evident when we recognize that the most recently discovered subatomic particles
(quarks) are now known to be frequency-like in their behavior. The growing
recognition of the frequency-like nature of elemental particles is a necessary step
on the evolutionary path toward science’s ultimate discovery of the
multidimensional structure of matter and the universe itself. The table below
provides a brief overview of this evolution.
Evolution of Physics from a Particle (Physical) Science to a Frequency-
Wave (Nonphysical) Science
1897 Electron discovered
1900 Quantum hypothesis (Max Planck)
1905 Photon theory (Einstein)
1905 Special theory of relativity (Einstein)
1908 Space-time (Hermann Minkowski)
1911 Nucleus discovered
1913 Special-orbits model of the atom (Niels Bohr)
1915 General theory of relativity (Einstein)
1924 Matter waves (Louis de Broglie)
1924 First concept of probability waves (Niels Bohr, H. A. Kramers, John Slater)
1925 Exclusion principle (Wolfgang Pauli)
1925 Matrix mechanics (Werner Heisenberg)
1926 Probability interpretation of wave function (Max Born)
1926 Schrodinger wave equation (Erwin Schrodinger)
1926 Matrix mechanics equated with wave mechanics (Schrodinger)
1927 Copenhagen interpretation of quantum mechanics: there is no deep reality—
observation affects reality
1927 Uncertainty principle (Werner Heisenberg)
1927 Davisson-Germer experiment (ClintonDavisson, Lester Germer)
1928 Antimatter (Paul Dirac)
1932 Neutron discovered
1932 Positron discovered
1932 Quantum logic (John von Neumann)
1935 Einstein-Rosen Bridge paper (Albert Einstein, Boris Podolsky, Nathan Rosen)
1935 Meson predicted (Hideki Yukawa)
1947 Meson discovered
1949 Feynman diagrams (Richard Feynman)
1947—1954 Sixteen new wavelike particles discovered
1957 Many worlds interpretation of quantum mechanics (Hugh Everett)
1958 One-way membrane hypothesis (David Finkelstein)
1961 Black hole map to parallel universe (Martin Kruskal)
1962 Quasars discovered
1963 Spinning black hole connecting an infinite series of parallel universes (Roy P.
Kerr)
1964 Quarks hypothesized
1964 Bell’s theorem (J. S. Bell)
1970 Implicate order (David Bohm)
1971 Nonlocal connections (Bell theorem) (Henry Stapp)
1972 Freedman-Clauser experiment (Stuart Freedman, John Clauser)
1974—1977 Twelve new wavelike particles discovered
1982 Aspect experiment (Alain Aspect)
1993 Gravitational waves (Huise and Taylor)
In the twenty-first century, science will recognize that the substructure of the
universe is indeed a nonphysical continuum of energy. This recognition will initiate
a renaissance of scientific discoveries relating to the unseen structure of matter and
the universe itself. Scientific nonphysical exploration will open the door to a new
world of opportunities and knowledge.
From astrophysics to philosophy, the established scientific observations and
conclusions will begin to be reexamined and reappraised. The new knowledge
obtained from scientific out-of-body exploration will empower each science to see
beyond the dense molecular forms and peer within the very heart of matter. Our
current scientific data are largely the result of molecular observations. The subtle
underlying structures and energy systems remain undiscovered. The traditional
scientific method and its dependence upon physical technology will eventually
evolve into a cooperative merger of physical and nonphysical research techniques.
In the twenty-first century, the interaction between physical technology and human
consciousness will become a science in and of itself. Just imagine what could be
gained if a team of respected scientists and researchers were trained to explore
out-of-body. Physicists could personally observe the undiscovered building blocks of
matter. Medical researchers could explore the unseen energy forces that cause
cancers, AIDS, cellular decay and disorders. Chemists could document the invisible
energy that influences and controls molecular change.
Biologists could investigate the very essence of physical life, and psychologists
could explore the invisible inner realms of the mind. Thousands of bright, curious
researchers today are hungry to discover and explore the unseen structure of
matter. Many of them have a burning desire to observe beyond the current limits of
technology and are looking for an opportunity to expand their vision beyond the
maze of quantum theories. Only consciousness can observe and record the multiple
complexities of space-time and thought-created realities. The door is now open for
those who have the courage to step away from their physical preconceptions and
explore the quantum realms of energy. The well-known physicist and author Fred
Alan Wolf concludes his Parallel Universes by stating:
The human mind is the laboratory of the new physics. It already is tuned to the
past and the future, making existential certainties out of probable realities. It does
this by simply observing. Observing oneself in a dream. Observing oneself in this
world when awake. Observing the action of observing. If we are brave enough to
venture into this world with consciousness as our ally, through our dreams and
altered states of awareness, we may be able to alter the hologram by bringing
more conscious “light” to the hell worlds that also exist side-by-side with our own.
It is time to speed up the process of illuminating the hologram, time to bring in the
big laser of consciousness. It is time to know this universe place for the first time
ever.
Continuum of Consciousness
The non-mathematician is seized by a mysterious shuddering when he hears of “four
dimensional” things, by a feeling not unlike that awakened by thoughts of the occult.
And yet there is no more commonplace statement than that the world in which we live is
a four-dimensional continuum.
—Albert Einstein
Consciousness is a continuum extending from physical wakefulness through
progressive states of awareness into nonphysical areas of the universe existing far
beyond our current scientific vision. This continuum of consciousness is as large
and diverse as the universe itself; each time we “fall” to sleep we are shifting our
awareness inwardly within the continuum. Each dream, meditation, and hypnosis
session is a partial glimpse into our personal continuum of consciousness. Our
recognition of this is a major step forward in our evolution. It’s only natural that
first we must explore the different states of consciousness experienced during
sleep, meditation, and lucid dreams before we can begin to recognize that these
states of awareness are linked by a common flow of consciousness. All states of
awareness are connected; even death is the movement of consciousness from one
area of the continuum to another. The continuum of consciousness is not just
another theory, but a fact that each of us can observe and verify for ourselves.
Controlled out-of-body experiences give us the unique opportunity to explore the
continuum of energy firsthand. In a sense, our awareness is like a light that has the
natural ability to illuminate any portion of the universe. Wherever we focus our
light, that area of the universe (in the physical body or out) becomes conscious and
real to us.
All movement of consciousness is inward within the nonphysical interior of the
universe. The states of awareness we currently perceive are only a tiny fraction of
the whole. The continuum extends deep into nonphysical areas of the universe far
beyond our current physical comprehension.
The states of consciousness illustrated above are not the continuum itself but our
modes or methods of perceiving this continuum of consciousness. The various
states of consciousness, such as meditative, hypnagogic, and hypnotic, obviously
overlap and exist differently for different people. Meditative states, for example,
can extend over the entire spectrum of the consciousness continuum, but most
people experience only a peaceful state of relaxation occurring in the light alpha
range. The vast majority of those who practice meditation are not highly trained
yogic masters who can control and extend their awareness at will.
It is important to recognize that our individual states of consciousness exist as
perceptions or segments of a whole. This recognition is the first major step in
understanding the nonphysical essence and function of consciousness. Such an
understanding is critically important because all the mysteries of our existence and
the universe itself are related to consciousness. This will be confirmed in the near
future when it is discovered that our individual consciousness is a microcosm of the
universe itself. Dreams, out-of-body experiences, and near-death experiences are
the recognition of our awareness as we move beyond the physical viewpoint and
explore the nonphysical continuum of consciousness. This concept of human
consciousness moving through an unseen universe is gaining support.
Physicist and author Fred Alan Wolf postulates that lucid dreams are actually visits
to parallel universes. He has repeatedly stated that lucid dreams might better be
called “parallel universe awareness. The states of consciousness that we are
currently aware of are, I contend, but a tiny fraction of the continuum that we will
experience after we permanently shed our physical bodies. Each year millions of
near-death and out-of-body experiences provide convincing evidence that this is
true. Observations obtained when out-of-body show that our current concepts of
consciousness and awareness are severely limited. Physical-based states of
consciousness are relatively crude and encumbered when compared with the
nonphysical states. Once we transcend our biological vehicles, we are free to
experience the unlimited essence of our consciousness. This essence exists and
extends far beyond our imagination. The continuum of consciousness extends
inwardly to the very heart of the universe; unending levels and frequencies of
nonphysical life and realities exist just beyond the dense limits of our sight. Each of
us has much to look forward to: incredible worlds of beauty and light patiently
waiting for us to explore. To experience this ourselves, we must simply extend our
awareness beyond our physical body and explore our individual continuum of
consciousness.
Evolution of Consciousness
Our current concept of evolution derives from the Darwinian theory that biological
organisms adapt and change in response to the physical conditions around them.
This theory, built entirely upon the observed changes of biological organisms, has
remained the scientific basis of evolution for over one hundred years.
Millions of reported out-of-body experiences provide convincing evidence that our
evolution is far more complex than the biological changes we observe around us. In
fact, out-of-body experiences point to an entire new vision of evolution, one that is
more comprehensive than any previous theory in human history. On the basis of
nonphysical explorations, we can say that evolution is the progressive development
of conscious energy (soul) through the use of temporary biological vehicles of
expression. Biological birth and death are simply the entrance and exit of
consciousness within this dense outer dimension of energy. The observed changes
of biological organisms are actually a secondary effect, created by the unseen
development of consciousness.
Currently, evolutionists observe and record only the outer physical changes
occurring around us, while the truly important changes remain unseen. Every day
we encounter new situations that psychologically stretch and mold us. Every
physical problem is a new opportunity to grow; each hardship helps us to develop
our inner qualities of courage, love, and compassion; each new challenge is an
opportunity to learn. In a sense, each of us uses matter as a tool of transformation.
Our biological bodies are temporary vehicles for expression and experience in this
dense realm of matter. The very act of assuming physical form and being human is
an integral element of our development. Each of us is currently experiencing the
most effective system of growth ever devised: evolution by direct personal
experience, by the very act of being. It doesn’t matter what we believe or don’t
believe; each of us will shed our temporary biological vehicle and continue to
evolve. We are all active participants in a magnificent evolutionary system that
extends far beyond the narrow limits of our physical vision. Birth and death
themselves are essential elements of our progress—the entrance and exit of
consciousness upon the molecular playing field of evolution.
Over the last twenty years, new insights concerning our spiritual existence have
emerged. Two decades ago, subjects such as near-death experiences, out-of-body
experiences, parallel universes, multiple dimensions, and energy tunnels between
universes were unknown to the vast majority of our species.
Today, these topics are debated in households around the world. In a single
generation, our concepts of reality have dramatically changed. This shift will
continue as people open their minds to a new vision of themselves and their
existence. Throughout history the evolution of human consciousness has been
molded by countless people worldwide. The following are a few examples of
individuals who have influenced the group consciousness and evolution of our
species in the last few decades. This process of human evolution will accelerate in
the next millennium as we expand our search for answers beyond the dense limits
of matter.
In 1975 Dr. Raymond Moody’s book Life After Life created an international
explosion of interest in the topic of life after death and possible nonphysical
realities. Moody’s groundbreaking work on near-death and altered states of
perception continues to influence millions of people around the world. Since 1975
the overwhelming acceptance of his many books has opened up an entirely new
field of study and research. Moody’s work has especially affected the medical
community, setting the stage for hundreds of medical researchers—among them
Drs. Melvin Morse and Brian Weiss—to delve into the many mysteries of
nonphysical experiences. To a great extent his work has legitimized the entire
subject of nonphysical research and the exploration of the unseen universe.
Moody’s work has helped to initiate a dramatic shift of thought, both conscious and
unconscious.
Kenneth Ring, Stuart Twemlow, Bruce Greyson, and other visionary physicians have
assisted the evolution of human consciousness by investigating the worldwide
reports of out-of-body and near-death experiences. Their research and insights
have helped legitimize the subject of nonphysical experiences, thus setting the
stage for innovative new explorations.
Brian Weiss has been instrumental in the growing worldwide acceptance of past-life
regression therapy as a valuable healing tool. Increasingly, psychologists and
psychiatrists are incorporating regression techniques into their daily practices.
Weiss’s work is a major step forward in the recognition of the relationship between
nonphysical states of consciousness and our current physical existence. In addition,
his books point out the importance and potential of obtaining self-knowledge.
John Stewart Bell, the Irish physicist who developed the interconnectedness
theorem, proved that all particles of matter are connected by an invisible (nonlocal)
force. His work has dramatically influenced the direction of modern physics. Many
physicists believe that the interconnectedness theorem is one of the most
important discoveries of the twentieth century.
Hugh Everett, Roy Kerr, Martin Kruskal, and other physicists and mathematicians
have developed theories and conceptual maps that assume the existence of
innumerable parallel universes as real as our own. This idea of parallel energy
worlds has influenced quantum theorists, astrophysicists, and astronomers
worldwide.
Filmmakers such as Steven Spielberg, through movies such as E. T and Close
Encounters of the Third Kind, reduce our fears of the unknown and open us to new
possibilities existing beyond our physical perceptions.
Gary Zukav’s clear insights into the relationship of physics and consciousness and
his search for the meaning and purpose of life have influenced millions.
Shakti Gawain’s clear message of the importance of creative visualization has
affected millions of people around the world.
Physicist and writer Fred Alan Wolf has presented and clarified the concepts of
parallel universes and consciousness-created reality to both the scientific
community and the general population. Drs. Wayne Dyer, Bernie Siegel, Deepak
Chopra, and many others have shown us through thought and deed how important
the connection is between body, mind, and spirit.
Bruce Joel Rubin’s vivid, thought-provoking portrayals of life, death, and unseen
energy dimensions (Jacob’s Ladder, Ghost, My Life) have been seen by over a halfbillion
people. Norman Vincent Peale’s uplifting message of positive thinking and its
effect upon matter and life has affected us all.
Albert Einstein moved scientific thought and theory beyond Newtonian physics into
expansive new realms of curved space-time and energy bridges to other universes.
In doing so, he set the stage for the emergence of modern quantum physics, the
concept of parallel universes, and the many worlds interpretation.
David Bohm, another visionary physicist, has originated numerous ideas concerning
consciousness-created reality and unseen energy substructures. His concepts have
influenced modern physics and are a major intellectual step toward the recognition
of the multidimensional nature of the universe. His piercing intellect has inspired an
entire new generation of physicists to look beyond the particles of matter for the
answers to reality.
Four excellent writers, Nick Herbert, Michael Talbot, Heinze Pagels, and Fritjof
Capra, have influenced the evolution of human consciousness by clearly portraying
the connection between new physics, metaphysics, religion, and consciousness.
Robert Monroe, a modern pioneer, has been instrumental in presenting the subject
of out-of-body exploration to millions of people around the world. His books and
research organization, the Monroe Institute, provide ongoing training, information,
support, and classes related to expanded awareness and nonphysical exploration.
Paul Twitchell is the modern founder of ECKANKAR. His many books (more than
thirty) introduced and detailed the historical influence of out-of-body exploration
upon the evolution of the human race.
Considered by some to have been a modern master of out-of-body travel, he was
instrumental in introducing the subject of nonphysical explorations to people
throughout the world.
Movie producers such as George Lucas and Gene Rodenberry have helped to
expand human imagination beyond earthbound visions of reality. Their images of
the future encourage all of us to see beyond the dense limits we now experience.
Science fiction writers, as a group, are some of our most talented visionaries. For
those who may doubt, remember the farfetched stories of Jules Verne; his
nineteenth-century submarines, spaceships, airships, and lunar explorations were
considered outrageous ideas in his day.
Betty Eadie, the author of Embraced by the Light, and others who have come
forward to share their near-death experiences will continue to have an impact on
the collective unconscious of humankind. Their uplifting accounts of personal
journeys within the magnificent unseen dimensions of the universe have sparked
worldwide debate and interest in the concepts of nonphysical realities and our place
in the universe. These personal accounts of nonphysical explorations within the
inner dimensions of the universe provide more than just comforting evidence of our
immortality. Millions of people are awakening to the realization that answers to the
mysteries of our existence are available. An important question is emerging: if a
few of us can experience and explore the nonphysical realms of the universe, then
why can’t all of us? This realization is a major step in the growth of the human
race. This process of change is inevitable, since all of us are approaching a time
where we will shed our biological vehicles and enter the nonphysical dimensions of
the universe. The significance of these nonphysical explorations into the interior of
the universe is not the stories themselves, but the realization that such
explorations are possible and even obtainable by all of us.
As the evolution of consciousness continues, more individuals will step forward to
offer new and daring insights into the nature of reality and the purpose of our
existence. Our evolution will continue to be influenced by people from many walks
of life: writers, musicians, inventors, healers, movie producers and directors. Often
they will be unaware of their impact on society. Their ideas and images go out into
the world like ripples on the surface of a pond, creating a slight movement of
thought and consciousness for millions of people. For example, the movies E. T,
Cocoon, and Ghost appear on the surface to be lighthearted adventure fantasies;
however, the nearly two billion people who watched these movies came away with
a new viewpoint about areas of life unknown and unexplored by modern science.
For many, their fears of the unknown were replaced by a sense of wonder and
positive anticipation. The collective unconscious of our entire species was influenced
by the ideas conveyed. Our fears of the unknown both consciously and
subconsciously were slightly reduced by the positive and uplifting images
communicated.
In the twenty-first century, a new form of entertainment and imagery will escort us
into the nonphysical levels of the universe. This will be a gradual evolution from
traditional movies to increasingly interactive adventures implementing virtualreality
technology. In the twenty-first century, virtual-reality programming will
become a popular springboard for self-controlled out-of-body explorations into the
interior of the universe. As we progress, it will become evident that the evolution of
technology and the evolution of human consciousness are interrelated in ways
beyond our current comprehension. Eventually, each of us will evolve beyond the
chrysalis of matter and explore within the nonphysical dimensions of the universe.
Future Evolution
In the last few years of my nonphysical explorations, I’ve come to realize that the
more experienced and familiar we are with the nonphysical dimensions of the
universe, the more expansive are our choices after our physical death. The
nonphysical (spiritual) options available to us increase exponentially with our ability
to explore the source of all energy and life. This is more important than I can begin
to express. The vast majority of humanity dies in complete ignorance of its spiritual
existence. Even though many people possess firm religious beliefs, their firsthand
knowledge of their spiritual identity and their continuing existence after death is
zero. At the moment of death, they transfer their consciousness from their physical
body to their higher-frequency nonphysical form and are immediately met by their
passed-on loved ones and friends. Of course they’re thrilled to discover that they
continue to exist, and are overjoyed to be reunited with their loved ones. Over the
next few days and weeks they are reintegrated into a new vibrational reality and
begin to adapt and conform within their respective social groups. This collective
feeling of togetherness brings and holds millions of people together in magnificent
nonphysical consensus environments.
Different groups of people hold different concepts of heaven. For example, the
Islamic perspective differs from the Christian viewpoint. Keep in mind that the
nonphysical environments are thought-responsive; each major religion and social
group has created its own concept of heaven according to that group’s beliefs and
convictions. Many of these energy environments are extremely old and well
established by the collective consciousness of their inhabitants. As a result, the
heaven that each of us experiences after death is molded by the group
consciousness of its nonphysical inhabitants. Much as in the physical world, most
people are content to adapt to the consensus reality inhabited and created by their
friends and loved ones. And why not? It’s incredibly pleasant when compared to
matter. There are magnificent landscapes and environments to discover and
explore. All the most beautiful and inspiring sights of earth are available, plus much
more. Every tree and blade of grass radiate a vibrant spectrum of color that’s
beyond our imagination. Everything— plants, animals, the earth itself—is composed
of light. A matrix of thoughtresponsive energy manifests whatever the inhabitants
focus upon. It’s only natural that the inhabitants would conclude that this must be
the ultimate reality—heaven.
These magnificent nonphysical environments are assumed to be heaven, and
compared with physical existence, these consensus environments are heaven—they
are free of death, disease, decay, crime, and so on. There’s only one problem: the
vast majority of the nonphysical inhabitants (billions of them) are unaware that
other, even more magnificent energy dimensions exist just beyond the limits of
their nonphysical perception. These spectacular energy dimensions consist of
endless frequencies of pure energy and light, each more radiant than the last—a
progression of living light existing far beyond our frail concepts of form and
substance and continuing into the very heart of the multidimensional universe.
This information is important because the first step to expanding our awareness is
to recognize the various limits we place upon ourselves, both physically and
spiritually. This knowledge points out the need for all of us to extend our perception
and experience beyond the dense limits around us. Once we develop an ability to
explore beyond the boundaries of our bodies, we can implement the same ability in
our future existence within our nonphysical home.
Developing our ability to explore beyond the body has profound implications for all
of us. Our ability to experience the various nonphysical frequency levels of the
universe depends upon our personal ability to transcend our current energy limits.
In effect, once we learn to transcend our physical limits, we can use the same
ability after death to experience even greater regions of the universe. Currently
there are those who can raise their personal vibratory rate and explore multiple
dimensions of the universe. These unique individuals are not limited to a single
dimension or environment. The ability to explore beyond our current physical limits
is an essential element of our evolution from physically immersed creatures to
unlimited spiritual beings. Only by transcending our dense limits can we ever hope
to consciously express ourselves throughout the multidimensional universe. It is
our destiny to evolve to the point where all of us will have the ability to extend
ourselves, our consciousness, through the entire length and breadth of the
universe. All of us are interdimensional beings currently focusing our attention upon
a single dimension of energymatter.
Out-of-body and near-death experiences, dreams, altered states of consciousness,
even death itself are evidence of our multidimensional nature. Consciously
recognizing and personally experiencing our nonphysical nature is a major step in
our individual evolution. Eventually all of us will evolve to the point where we are
able to consciously experience and explore the entire universe. This will occur when
our species grows to recognize that we and the universe are the same—
multidimensional.
After twenty years of personal out-of-body exploration, I am certain that we are
evolving through matter. We are using bio-logical life-forms as instruments of
expression. Our physical bodies are the tools we use for experience and growth.
Each birth (exploration) into matter furthers our progress by increasing our
experience. Every physical life-form is using and controlling a temporary biological
vehicle for its evolution. Like the proverbial butterfly, each living organism sheds its
temporary biological vehicle in order to continue its journey within the refined
energy levels of the multidimensional universe.
Evolution is much more than our eyes can see. It is the movement and change of
consciousness from the simpler, biological life-forms to the progressively more
complex and organized, nonphysical life-forms. Each life-form continues its
evolutionary journey within the multidimensional universe. Each continues to grow
and change, slowly learning and adapting to its new challenges and adventures, to
its new forms of expression. To truly comprehend evolution, we must explore and
observe the sub-structure of the universe: the nonmolecular energy structures and
systems that cause the physical changes we perceive around us.
Einstein’s Dream
The dream of Einstein and every other physicist has been to understand and
explain the structure of the universe. For many decades, physicists have hoped to
discover a single theory that explains and unites all energy, space, and time
concepts. This single unified theory is often referred to as grand unification.
Most physicists now believe that undiscovered energy reactions are occurring just
beyond our current technological vision. As modern science explored into the heart
of matter, an incredible discovery was made: elemental physical particles possess
no inherent material attributes or properties. The primary building blocks of matter
become progressively frequency-like. This discovery has far-reaching implications.
When we recognize the frequency-like nature of physical particles, the concepts of
multiple dimensions of energy are not as far-fetched as they may first appear. For
example, Newton’s classic experiment with the prism showed that visible light
contains different frequencies that appear as colors. The various light frequencies
exist together within the same space-time that we observe, yet each frequency of
light also exists completely separate from the others.
The electromagnetic wave spectrum displays an incredible array of radiation, from
gamma rays to long radio waves. Since different frequencies of energy coexist
within the same space-time that we occupy, why couldn’t entire energy
environments and possibly even worlds coexist with our visible physical universe?
This question is taken seriously by modern physicists around the world. Physicists
are now convinced that something of substantial proportion exists just beyond our
technological vision. This unseen and unexplored energy is thought to be the key to
understanding the structure of matter and the universe.
I believe that Einstein’s ultimate dream of grand unification can be realized by
developing new methods to explore and verify the reality of the multidimensional
universe. The scientific recognition of the multidimensional universe and the
continuum of consciousness is the primary missing element in our comprehension
of the unseen nature and structure of all energy throughout the universe. Grand
unification can be realized if modern physicists are willing to refocus their attention
from elementary particles to nonphysical wave function. This is not a dream but a
reality patiently waiting for our scientific perceptions to evolve beyond their current
obsession with physical particles.
The New Frontier of Science
In the twenty-first century, science will recognize that the answers to the elusive
physical mysteries of our existence—the cosmology of the universe, the unseen
nature and structure of matter, the evolution of our species, and even the existence
of life after death—can be found only by exploring the unseen substructure of the
universe. This recognition will be a major evolutionary step of science and a turning
point in human evolution. Slowly we will move from being an externally focused,
biological species to being an increasingly multidimensional species. This process of
change has already begun. Astrophysicists, quantum physicists, and particle
physicists are even now conducting extensive experiments that support the concept
of a multidimensional universe. This trend will continue throughout the twenty-first
century. Once we begin to explore the interior of the universe, a new age of
scientific research and discovery will emerge. Modern science will expand its current
observations of matter and reality beyond all current concepts. Science will begin to
explore the unseen source of physical energy and matter. As we evolve, we will
begin to chart the unseen universe much as astronomers are now charting the
visible universe. The exploration of the interior of the universe is a massive
endeavor reaching far beyond our current intellectual concepts of time, space, and
energy. The exploration of the unseen dimensions is a task that all of us will
eventually confront, for it is our birthright and our destiny to explore beyond our
primitive biological vehicles and experience the magnificence of our true home
within the multidimensional universe.
CHAPTER 4
Transformative Qualities
Knowledge is the antidote for fear.
—Ralph Waldo Emerson
The benefits of out-of-body exploration extend far beyond the limits of our physical
senses and our intellect. After an out-of-body experience, many people report an
inner awakening of their spiritual identity, a transformation of their self-concept.
They see themselves as more than matter—more aware and alive. They express a
profound inner wisdom based on personal spiritual experience. Many report being
connected to something greater than themselves, connected to the very source of
life itself. They describe a powerful feeling of breaking through a dense barrier of
ignorance, fear, and limitation. During my workshops, I often hear reports of an
increase in personal knowledge and an inner connection to spirit. Many describe a
dramatic expansion of their ability to perceive—-a new capability extending far
beyond their physical limits; an overwhelming sense of knowing based on direct
personal experience.
Perhaps the most important benefit of out-of-body experiences is that we recognize
our personal ability to discover the answers for ourselves. When I am asked, “Why
out-of-body exploration?” my response is simple: I need to know the answers for
myself. I find little comfort in beliefs, especially since they are the most abundant
commodity available today. Every society, every culture is overflowing with its
version of the truth—a man-made collection of solid convictions. These beliefs
change with time, evolving and decaying, while the truth of our existence remains
the same, hidden under the ever-growing mountain of doctrines, dogmas,
assumptions, and conclusions.
I believe that the purpose of life is experience. We must experience and explore for
ourselves. We must discover and know, or be a slave to other people’s opinions. As
the twenty-first century approaches, the time has come for us to recognize our true
potential and to explore beyond the prevailing beliefs and convictions. The time has
come for us to discover and see the truth for ourselves.
We have this opportunity today. Controlled out-of-body experiences open the door
to an incredible new frontier of human potential and discovery. They allow us to
explore beyond the narrow limits of our physical senses and discover the answers
to the oldest mysteries of our existence.
Transformative Qualities of Out-of-Body Experiences
According to research and studies conducted by many highly respected physicians—
among them, Raymond Moody, Melvin Morse, Ken Ring, Bruce Greyson, and Stuart
Twemlow—the transformative qualities of out-of-body experiences are limitless.
Each year new studies point to additional psychological and physical benefits
derived from out-of-body experiences. As I research this topic, I realize that the
number of reported benefits is absolutely staggering.
As reported out-of-body experiences increase, the evidence is overwhelming that
life-changing benefits are regularly obtained during these out-of-body adventures.
The following is presented as an overview of the many benefits reported worldwide
in the last twenty years.
1. Greater awareness of reality. According to an in-depth study conducted by
Stuart Twemlow, M.D., Glen Cabbard, M.D., and Fowler Jones, Ed.D., and
presented at the 1980 annual meeting of the American Psychiatric Association, 86
percent of their 339 out-of-body participants reported a greater awareness of
reality. In the same survey, 78 percent believed that they received a lasting
benefit.
2. Personal verification of our immortality. Without a doubt, out-of-body
experiences provide firsthand, verifiable evidence of our ability to exist independent
of our physical bodies. This is a powerful, life-changing event for millions of people
each year.
3. Accelerated personal development. Recognizing that we are more than
physical beings opens entirely new levels of personal development. I strongly
believe that self-initiated and controlled out-of-body experiences are the cutting
edge of accelerated personal development. Once we consciously access and control
our nonphysical self, we can unlock the unlimited knowledge of our subconscious
mind and harness our ability to explore the universe. The entire subject of human
potential is dramatically expanded beyond all current concepts and comprehension.
4. Decreased fear of death. When we experience ourselves consciously separated
from and independent of our physical bodies, our fear of death is noticeably
reduced. Fear of death is fear of the unknown. Once you separate from your body,
you absolutely know that you continue. I have found that the more out-of-body
experiences we have, the less we harbor fears and anxiety about death.
5. Increased psychic abilities. Precognition, telepathy, premonitions, prophecy,
the ability to see auras, and many other psychic abilities are often enhanced by
out-of-body experiences. The reason for this is currently unknown, but many
believe that it is simply a natural result of our becoming more attuned to our
internal energy systems.
6. Increased desire for answers. Once they recognize that answers are
available, many people begin a personal spiritual quest to solve the mysteries they
have pondered since childhood.
7. Realizations concerning death. Out-of-body experiences provide evidence
that the process of dying may not be a painful or scary experience but rather a
wondrous, spiritual adventure.
8. Accelerated human evolution. True evolution of our species is not the
biological change around us but the evolution of consciousness. As our world
becomes progressively more complex, there is an inner need to discover the
unseen reason behind the rapid physical changes we perceive around us. This need
to know the answers to the many mysteries that surround us will take our species
into the next level of human evolution. When we look back at human evolution, we
see a transition from physical labor-based (agricultural) societies to increasingly
intellectual-based (technological) societies. Eventually our species will be ready for
the next major evolutionary step—the recognition and experience of our
nonphysical self and the exploration of the nonphysical dimensions.
9. Spontaneous healing. There are numerous reports of people healing
themselves and others when out-of-body. Often this healing is initiated by a
focused thought directed to a specific area of the body.
10. More expansive self-concept. Instead of viewing themselves as physical
beings possessing souls, many recognize themselves as souls (consciousness)
temporarily possessing biological bodies.
11. Increased spirituality. According to the previously mentioned study
conducted by Dr. Stuart Twemlow, 55 percent of the participants referred to their
out-of-body experience as a spiritual experience. Many people report a deeper
connection to their spiritual essence, profound insights into their spiritual nature, or
a definite sense of being connected to something far greater than themselves.
Whether we call it spirit or the universal mind of God, there are consistent reports
of a powerful inner connection.
12. Past-life influences recognized and experienced. The work of Brian Weiss
and other respected physicians and hypnotherapists has provided convincing
evidence that past-life influences are an important element of our current
psychological makeup. These subconscious memories can be effectively accessed
and explored through personal out-of-body experiences.
13. Accelerated psychological change. Out-of-body experiences help us break
free of old mental ruts and habits. On many occasions, individuals have told me
that the shock of experiencing themselves independent of their physical body gave
them a more enlightened perspective of their current existence. This expansive
vision of themselves has been instrumental in awakening new levels of personal
growth and understanding.
14. Obtaining personal answers. Each of us has questions relating to his or her
existence. What am I? What is my purpose? Do I continue? What is the meaning of
life? These questions and many more can be answered only through personal
experience. Out-of-body exploration provides a powerful method for all of us to
obtain the answers we seek. Why settle for beliefs when the answers are available?
15. Encountering a being of light, an angel, or another nonphysical
resident. Many people report face-to-face meetings with some form of nonphysical
inhabitant. Thirty-seven percent of Twemlow’s study group were aware of the
presence of a nonphysical being, while 30 percent reported the presence of guides
or helpers.
16. Increased respect for life. A pronounced aversion to violence and killing
seems to appear. For example, the idea of hunting and killing an animal becomes
repugnant. I believe this change owes to the personal knowledge we obtain
concerning our spiritual interconnectiveness.
17. Increased self-respect, self-responsibility, and inner dependence. Many
people recognize for the first time that they are the creative center of their physical
existence. They often experience the vast potential and power of their inner,
nonphysical self and tap into their creative essence. Many people have told me that
they realize more than ever that they are completely responsible for all their
actions, both thoughts and deeds.
18. Reduced hostility, violence, and crime. Those who experience themselves
as more than just their bodies often realize the self-destructiveness of stealing or
harming another person. Owing to their personal recognition that they truly do
continue after death, they realize that their personal responsibility also continues.
19. Increased knowledge and wisdom. Only experience creates wisdom, and
out-of-body experiences have the unique ability to provide knowledge and wisdom
far beyond the limits of our physical perceptions.
20. Profound sense of knowing instead of believing. Personal knowledge is
powerful and life changing, especially when compared with beliefs. Out-of-body
experiences provide firsthand, verifiable knowledge of our immortality and our
spiritual identity. This knowledge cannot be adequately explained; it must be
experienced.
21.Inner calm. A feeling of peace comes from knowing instead of hoping that we
are immortal.
22. Increased zest for living. There is a certain difficult-to-describe excitement
inherent in out-of-body exploration—an exhilaration that reaches deep into the very
core of our being. When we separate from our physical body and actively explore
our surroundings, we know deep down that we have become the ultimate
explorers. We realize that we are much greater than our current physical
personality or ego. Life itself becomes an adventure, an exciting journey of
discovery. The inner excitement we feel is unmistakable; it comes from an inner
knowing that we are blazing a path far ahead of our time.
23. Increased intelligence and memory recall; enhanced imagination. Many
people report that their out-of-body experiences have somehow enhanced their
awareness and intelligence. Some believe that out-of-body experiences may
stimulate areas of the brain previously untapped during normal physical life. From a
biological point of view, this could be a stimulation of the right temporal lobe or the
pineal gland. The medical reason for the reported result is unknown, but according
to extensive research conducted by Wilder Penfield, a Canadian neurosurgeon,
when the right temporal lobe is stimulated by a mild electrical charge, patients
consistently report out-of-body experiences. In addition, there is substantial
evidence that the right temporal lobe is mysteriously activated during death and
near-death experiences. There is also research supporting the existence of a
connection between the biological brain and our nonphysical energy system. If this
is so, then maybe there are interactions both electrical and chemical of which we
are still unaware. This entire subject requires additional research.
24. Sense of adventure. Every day and night is an opportunity to experience a
new adventure. The author Tom Robbins may have said it best, “Our great human
adventure is the evolution of consciousness. We are in this life to enlarge the soul
and light up the brain.” The transformative qualities of out-of-body experiences are
a reality that each of us can experience. All we need is an open mind and the
proper guidance to access our unlimited personal potential. The ability to explore
unseen areas of the universe is now available, but it is up to us to take the step
from being a curious observer to becoming an active explorer. I believe this step is
an important turning point in our lives and our personal evolution. Exploring beyond
the limits of our physical bodies can be an effective way of obtaining the answers
and insights so many of us seek. This journey of consciousness from the physical to
the nonphysical is a reality we cannot escape; our only real decision is when we are
going to begin.
Physically Challenged
Out-of-body exploration offers tremendous benefits for millions of physically
challenged people around the world. For those who endure a lifetime of physical
limitation, out-of-body exploration provides an incredible rebirth of hope, joy, and
perception—an opportunity to experience themselves temporarily free of their
physical pain, disease, or disability. Just imagine the crippled girl who will never
walk being able to move effortlessly past the confines of her disabled physical body,
or the blind man who will never see his own face suddenly able to perceive beyond
the limits of physical sight. The potential is staggering.
The benefits of out-of-body exploration extend far beyond our current medical and
scientific comprehension. The medical profession has a long-standing history of
focusing primarily on the physical aspects of disease and disability. Because of this
physical emphasis and indoctrination, the exploration of expanded human potential
and perception to benefit the physically challenged is sadly lacking in our society.
Our natural ability to transcend our physical bodies allows us to temporarily step
away from any physical limitation we may currently experience. With the proper
guidance, preparation, and techniques, almost anyone can become proficient at
out-of-body exploration and experience the incredible joy of unrestricted freedom.
The startling reality of this unique form of exploration must be experienced for its
unlimited potential to be comprehended and fully appreciated. Intellectual
reasoning and analysis cannot give us this perception—we simply must experience
the truth of it for ourselves. My fondest hope is that we will open our hearts and
minds to this new potential of human growth and development. We have nothing to
lose but the most widespread disability of all—ignorance.
When attempting out-of-body exploration, physically challenged individuals often
possess a significant advantage over the general population. Their burning desire to
escape their physical limitations often creates a powerful incentive for change. This
desire and motivation is the single most important aspect of out-of-body
exploration.
The following is an out-of-body experience reported by a man who has been
paralyzed from the waist down for the last twenty years.
“Sitting in my wheelchair, I am reading a book about out-of-body experiences.
Being a sixty-three-year-old man with traditional upbringing, I seriously doubt that
this kind of thing is real. It sounds too strange to be true. In the book is a
visualization exercise that appears pretty simple. I decide, What the hell—it doesn’t
hurt to try it. I begin to picture my daughter’s home in my mind. I pretend I am at
her home and opening her front door. I mentally step into the living room and
begin to picture the furniture, carpet, windows, pictures, and even the plants. I’m
kind of surprised how easy and fun it is to do this. I pretend to walk over to the
coffee table and try to feel it. I sit down in a chair and try to feel the texture of the
upholstery.
The next thing I remember is a dream in which I am flying across a beautiful
meadow. Then I feel a strange vibration all through me. The noise becomes louder
and louder until I realize that I’m floating lust above my wheelchair. At first I’m
startled, but completely awake and aware. The floating sensation is wonderful. I
think about moving to the door and I instantly float to it. A feeling of joy flows
through me as I float through the door and around my house. I seem to glide
wherever I wish.
Gaining my courage, I decide to try flying. As I think about it my body turns in
midair. I spread my arms and picture myself flying like a bird. Instantly I’m gliding
like an eagle in the sky. I fly over my neighborhood and can see the homes below
me. For the first time in my life I know what true freedom really is. I think of my
physical body and I’m suddenly back in my wheelchair again. My heart is pounding
with excitement as I write this. The exhilaration of this experience is beyond words.
I only wish I had learned about this twenty years earlier.”
Benefits of Out-of-Body Exploration
• Discover and know for yourself the answer to humankind’s oldest mysteries: Do
we continue after death? What is the meaning of life?
• Answer the basic questions of your existence: What am I? Why am I here? What
is my purpose?
• Solve the mystery of your final destination: Where do we go at death? Does
“heaven” exist? What does it look like? Why is it a mystery?
• Observe and solve current physical problems from a “higher perspective.”
• Gain a greater understanding of the challenges and lessons you experience daily.
• Observe and understand the incredible, unseen power of thought-energy at work.
• Step beyond the labyrinth of beliefs and discover the truth yourself.
• Accelerate your personal evolution beyond the dense limits of matter.
• Confront and remove your personal fears.
• Gain a far clearer understanding of your life, your relationships, and your world.
• See and experience the magnificent beauty of our multidimensional universe.
• Realize your unlimited personal potential and power.
• Recognize and understand the unseen reasons for the past and present events in
your life.
• Enjoy absolute freedom of movement without limits.
• Gain a far greater understanding of modern religions.
• Discover and experience absolute, firsthand verification of your personal
immortality.
• Observe and comprehend the subtle energy currents that shape your life and your
world.
• Receive the knowledge and wisdom that comes only with experience.
• Recognize and free yourself from inaccurate opinions, conclusions, and belief
systems.
• See a clearer vision of the universal plan.
• Observe and understand the natural process of birth and death.
• See, experience, and explore the biblical “heaven” for yourself.
Joys of Out-of-Body Exploration
• The thrill of an exciting new adventure.
• The absolute joy of experiencing your personal immortality.
• The exhilaration of experiences and explorations beyond the ordinary.
• The overwhelming sense of personal accomplishment.
• The pure joy of exploring an uncharted, undiscovered terrain.
• The excitement of being a pioneer in a new field of exploration.
• The delight of discovering the truth of your existence beyond all beliefs and
assumptions.
• The intense, personal satisfaction of knowing firsthand the purpose and meaning
of your existence.
• The incredible feelings of knowing, instead of hoping.
• The joy of discovering new levels of personal growth and development.
• The overwhelming feelings of accelerated personal evolution.
• The intense, inner joy of solving ancient mysteries and discovering the answers
for yourself.
These benefits and much more await you; however, it’s up to you to explore and
experience the reality of this for yourself. Out-of-body exploration gives you the
rare opportunity to know and see, instead of hope and believe. This opportunity is
yours today.
CHAPTER 5
Developing Your Natural Ability
Sit down before fact like a small child, and be prepared to give up every preconceived
notion, follow humbly wherever and to whatever abyss nature lead, or you will learn
nothing.
—T. H. Huxley
Keep your mind open to change all the time. Welcome it. Court it. It is only by
examining and reexamining your opinions and ideas that you can progress.
—Dale Carnegie
Reappraising Our Concepts of Reality
Many psychological issues affect our ability to have an out-of-body experience. Our
self-concept and the way we view this subject have a tremendous influence on the
results we obtain. It’s quite common for personal limits, fears, and beliefs to inhibit
our ability to experience and enjoy our full potential. This is especially true when
we are embarking upon a new form of exploration.
The self-evaluation in the table below briefly reviews topics and issues that may
influence your ability to have an out-of-body experience. Your responses can offer
useful insights into your personal beliefs, assumptions, and conclusions concerning
this unique form of exploration.
As objectively as possible, examine your emotional and intellectual responses to
each question. If you discover an area that holds a potential limitation or conflict,
take your time and delve into it; look for the underlying reason for your current
beliefs.
Belief reappraisal is one of the most important aspects of out-of-body preparation. I
have found that conscious and subconscious fears, limits, and misconceptions are
the most common obstacles we confront in out-of-body exploration. Recognition of
our personal limits and fears is a major step forward in reducing or eliminating any
blocks we may experience. Take all the time you need and feel free to expand upon
any subject you believe is relevant. I recommend that you write your responses, in
as much detail as needed.
Self-Evaluation
1. Self-Concept What do you believe you are? How do you view yourself?
Describe your self-concept in detail.
2. Personal Viewpoints What are your perceptions and feelings concerning outof-
body experiences? Do you consider them an adventure?
3. Motivation Is your personal motivation to obtain answers? To solve a mystery
or a problem? Is it curiosity? Is it to obtain personal verification of some kind? Be
specific.
4. Safety Do you feel that it is completely safe to have an out-of-body
experience? Do you have any concerns, such as that you might become lost or die?
Be specific.
5. Special Ability or Talent Do you believe that some kind of special ability or
talent is required to have an out-of-body experience?
6. Importance Do you consider this exploration important to your personal
development? On a scale from 1—10, how important is it?
7. Desire Do you possess the inner desire and drive to follow through? What
benefits or information do you want from this experience? How strong is your
desire?
8. Commitment Are you willing to devote the time and effort needed to achieve
your goal? Are you willing to commit thirty minutes a day for a month?
9. Fears Are you anxious or fearful about this kind of exploration? Do you fear
the unknown, the dark, or new challenges? Are your fears logical or the result of a
lack of information?
10. Religious Beliefs How does out-of-body exploration fit into your religious
beliefs and concepts? Do you consider this a spiritual experience?
11. Degree of Difficulty Do you believe that this experience is natural and easy
or difficult to achieve? Why do you feel this way?
12. Confidence Are you confident that you can achieve your desired goals?
13. Expectations Do you expect positive results? What are your personal
expectations?
14. Personal Issues or Limits Are you aware of any personal issues that may
limit your ability to have an out-of-body experience? If so, write them down.
15. Goals Have you made this exploration a firm personal goal? Is it a written
goal? Is it an important goal? Is it a priority?
Many subjects covered in this self-evaluation do not require an explanation. A few
areas, though, may need further clarification.
COMMITMENT AND GOALS
Your positive attitude toward and commitment to out-of-body exploration are
essential to your success. If you pursue this exploration with halfhearted interest,
your results will reflect your desire. On the other hand, if you are passionate,
determined, and committed, your success is practically assured. It’s important to
make this exploration a personal priority for a specified time. In my workshops I
recommend a minimum thirty-day total commitment. I instruct each student to set
aside the time necessary to do at least one out-of-body technique daily. For thirty
days, focus as much mental and emotional energy as you can muster upon your
goal of a conscious out-of-body experience. For many people, writing out the goal
daily helps to crystallize it within their minds and emphasizes its importance.
For example, before bed each night write twenty times, “Now I have an out-of-body
experience,” “Now I have a fully conscious out-of-body experience,” or “Now I’m
out-of-body.”
When you make this exploration a personal priority and incorporate written goals,
the intensity of your commitment is magnified. In effect, you begin an almost
mystical chain of events—your inner commitment and desire begin to mold your
subconscious mind. Often your dreams become more memorable, and increasingly
lucid. Dreams involving movement, such as flying, are often reported. These
dreams are an indication that your subconscious mind is responding to your
commitment to an out-of-body experience. These dreams and the inner signals
associated with them are often an effective springboard to a fully conscious
experience. Write your goals today and make a firm personal commitment to follow
through.
WRITTEN GOALS
In a class I recently conducted, a woman asked me what single event or experience
had most influenced my ability to have out-of-body experiences. After some
thought, I realized that more than any other thing, my decision to make a written
list of personal spiritual goals had had a dramatic effect. For example, “I easily
separate from my physical body” and “I now experience my higher self.” As strange
as this may sound, committing my goals to paper had a powerful effect on the
results I experienced. During each out-of-body experience, my personal goals
seemed to flash in my mind at just the right moment for me to act on them. As I
progressed, my goals evolved. Often, after returning from an out-of-body
adventure, I would write my experience and realize that now I had several more
goals and questions. It’s as if each experience compounded itself. The power of
setting firm, written goals is evident; they focus our thoughts, both conscious and
subconscious. All things physical and nonphysical begin as a thought, and the more
specific our thoughts, the greater the probability of their manifestation.
During the first seconds of an out-of-body experience, our thoughts are critical to
the immediate results we experience. It’s quite common for our first focused
thought to propel us into a nonphysical environment or situation that is directly
related to that thought. Specific written goals create a strong imprint on the
subconscious mind and are more likely to be implemented by our nonphysical state
of consciousness. If they are used properly, it’s possible to program our out-ofbody
adventures toward a specific purpose or goal. The importance of this should
not be overlooked: it is the first step to effective, conscious control of the out-ofbody
state. This is the underlying reason why affirmations and visualization are so
effective.
FEARS AND LIMITS
Fears and limits exert an amazing control over our lives. Personal beliefs, limits,
and fears create invisible walls of anxiety around us. These feelings of anxiety
manifest themselves as the limits we experience in our daily lives. Fear, anxiety,
and the resulting limits are the number-one obstacle to success that we must face.
Each day we are confronted with decisions and choices that we must act upon.
These decisions determine the course of our lives and the results we experience.
If you look at the lives of successful people, you will notice that they share one
overriding attribute. All of them had to confront and overcome their fears and
limitations to reach their desired goals. Examples are the introverted actors,
musicians, and public speakers who have conquered their intense stage fright,
pilots who were once afraid of heights, and even the child who fears the dark.
Each fear and anxiety in our lives is a personal obstacle for us to overcome, a
personal barrier separating us from our desired goals. Life itself can be viewed as a
series of challenges and obstacles we must eventually confront and overcome. How
we react to each challenge will determine the personal accomplishments we
experience during our lives.
The fears and limits in our physical lives will many times affect our out-of-body
explorations as well. In effect, our fears will manifest as nonphysical walls and
barriers that restrict our freedom and mobility. For example, during the third year
of my out-of-body explorations, I experienced a large, heavy object pressing down
on me immediately after separation. I perceived the object to be an ornate, goldleaf
mirror; it was so massive that I was pinned under its crushing weight. I began
to push against the mirror with all my strength, trying again and again to remove
it. An intense despair flowed through me as the weight of the mirror continued to
crush me. In desperation, I focused all my attention, all my energy and strength,
on moving this pressing weight and screamed out, “I have the power.” Instantly, I
felt a surge of strength and easily lifted the mirror and tossed it aside. At that
moment, I experienced a powerful new sensation of freedom and mobility. I was as
light as a feather and able to go wherever I pleased. For the first time in my life, I
felt completely free, completely in control. I was able to move, perceive, and
comprehend at an accelerated rate. I somehow knew that I had opened the door to
new levels of personal possibilities and growth. Each fear and limit we experience is
an opportunity for us to learn and grow. Our recognition of this can assist us in
confronting each new challenge.
BELIEF
As surprising as it may sound, you don’t have to believe in out-of-body experiences
to have one. Countless individuals worldwide have reported spontaneous out-ofbody
experiences. Most of these people possessed no previous knowledge of or
belief in out-of-body travel. Several books are currently available by Raymond
Moody and other authors detailing such near-death and out-of-body experiences
and their dramatic results. Over twenty years ago when I first heard of this strange
phenomenon, I didn’t believe out-of-body experiences really existed. I had
concluded that so-called out-of-body travel was probably a weird hoax, a druginduced
experience, or some kind of extremely lucid dream. Out of halfhearted
curiosity, I decided to investigate these strange reports for myself. Looking back, I
realize that belief was unnecessary. Instead, curiosity was my greatest asset when
investigating this unique form of exploration.
PHYSICAL CONDITIONING AND INDOCTRINATION
Since birth each of us has received the most extensive conditioning that our society
and culture can muster. We have been conditioned to accept the assumption that
we are physical creatures—mammals with a mind. This physical indoctrination is
largely the result of a single undisputed conclusion passed down generation after
generation: since we experience and observe ourselves as physical beings, it’s only
natural to conclude that we are our bodies. Based on physical perceptions, this
appears to be a rational conclusion. What else could we be? As we grow, we are
repeatedly told that we are physical creatures. Every day of our lives this
conclusion is reinforced by family, friends, the mass media, and society in general.
Eventually we are taught a few nonphysical concepts, usually in the form of
religious beliefs. These nonphysical concepts are normally passed to us in a very
ambiguous manner. Most religions teach that we possess a soul or spirit of some
kind—an invisible, indescribable form of energy. We are told to believe this
mysterious concept without question, but are offered nothing as evidence—no facts,
no logic. We are told to have faith, for the answers are in God’s hands. Many
religious leaders would have us believe that we are practically powerless to obtain
the answers to the mysteries of our existence and of life.
The end result is a massive, double indoctrination. First we are taught that we are
mammals with a mind; then we are taught that we are powerless creatures of God,
unable to obtain the answers for ourselves.
There’s only one problem with these conclusions—they’re built entirely upon the
limited range of our physical senses. As any physicist will tell you, we see only a
tiny fraction of the energy around us. Basing our entire concept of reality on
physical perceptions alone is a formula destined to create incomplete conclusions,
not only about ourselves but about everything around us. A classic example is the
early perception that the earth was the center of the universe. For thousands of
years it was obvious to everyone that the sun revolved around the earth. In more
recent times, we were taught in science that the atom was constructed of tiny
particles spinning in harmony around a solid, stable nucleus. Today, according to
quantum mechanics, this neat, orderly picture of subatomic reality is inaccurate
and incomplete. One of the current universal conclusions taught in schools around
the world is the scientific assumption that the biological brain is the origin of
consciousness. Medical science concluded long ago that the brain is the obvious
source of all consciousness. What else could it be? Yet today, tens of millions of
out-of-body and near-death experiences provide clear evidence that our state of
consciousness continues even when we are separated from our physical body. The
first step in breaking free from our physical conditioning is to recognize its
existence. From now on, begin to pay attention to the many assumptions and
conclusions that make up your life. Notice all the subtle things that are built into
our society and everyday life. For example, listen for all the statements referring to
you and those around you as physical creatures: my hair, my skin, his arms, her
legs. This may sound trivial, but we hear these kinds of statements countless times
every day. Each statement referring to us as a physical body acts to condition us to
this self-concept. In hypnosis this is called a suggestion. It is proven that when
suggestions are repeated daily over a period of time, they will generate an
extremely effective conditioning of our minds.
Every year millions of people are conditioned by hypnotic suggestions to alter their
daily habits or behavior patterns— often in one or two sessions. For decades,
suggestions have been used successfully to stop smoking or alter eating habits. If
the human mind can be conditioned in one hour to change a lifelong habit such as
smoking or overeating, just imagine how powerful a lifetime of social conditioning
can be. In effect, the constant reference to us as physical creatures molds our selfimage
to accept this assumption as reality. This is especially powerful when modern
scientific and medical experts repeatedly reinforce the same assumptions. The
result is clear: we accept the self-image that we are indeed physical creatures.
This is without a doubt the greatest single falsehood dominating our species. In
truth, the physical body is simply a temporary biological vehicle that we are using
for expression in a dense environment. This is the primary reason that millions of
people who have had near-death and out-of-body experiences are so profoundly
changed by their experience. Often for the first time, they personally discover (not
believe or hope) that they are a spiritual being inhabiting a temporary physical
vehicle. This is a powerful, life-changing realization that is difficult to convey with
words alone. Just think for a moment of your entire self-concept being radically and
instantaneously changed forever. Many people don’t talk about such experiences at
all because they simply go far beyond current physical concepts of reality.
I believe that the underlying purpose of near-death and out-of-body experiences is
to give each of us a personal glimpse into our spiritual nature. Only by experiencing
our nonphysical-spiritual self can we completely overcome the restrictive influence
of our physical and social indoctrination. Only by stepping free from our dense,
physical limits can we know the truth of ourselves and our universe.
Anatomy of an Out-of-Body Experience
Just as specific elements are often present in near-death experiences, so the outof-
body experience has several commonly reported stages. The following are the
most often mentioned.
1.Vibrational Stage. At this stage, energy vibrations flow throughout the body.
Buzzing, humming, or roaring sounds, along with occasional numbness and
catalepsy (inability to move), often accompany the vibrations. The variation and
intensity of reported vibrations and sounds are immense; they can range from mild
and soothing to intense and startling. During the vibrational stage, our
consciousness is shifted to our nonphysical energy-body. The vibrations and sounds
(inner signals) are not physical events, as some believe, but the conscious
recognition of our higherfrequency body as it separates from (moves out of phase
with) our physical body.
2. Separation Stage. When the subtle energy-body separates from the physical
body, there is generally a distinct feeling of lifting, floating, or rolling out of the
physical. After separation is complete, the vibrations and sounds immediately
diminish.
3. Exploration Stage. Once we move away from and consciously exist
independent of the physical body, we can begin to explore the nonphysical
environment. The energy-body is often experienced as a duplicate of the physical
body but consisting of a higher-frequency form of energy. Because of its subtle
structure, the energy-body is extremely thought-responsive. The method of
mobility we use is completely unlimited; we can walk, run, fly, float. To maintain
our exploration, we must continue to focus our attention within the new
environment and energy-body we are experiencing.
4. Reentry Stage. Reentry—the reintegration of the subtle energy-body and the
physical body—automatically occurs by simply thinking about the physical body. On
occasion, during reentry the integration of the two bodies is accompanied by
temporary vibrations, numbness, and catalepsy. These sensations quickly fade as
we become reunited and in phase with our physical body.
Four Steps to Success
The first step to a successful, self-controlled out-of-body experience is to remain
mentally and emotionally calm as you begin to recognize any form of movement or
shift in your awareness. Your ability to remain calm is essential for achieving and
maintaining any degree of control when out-of-body. The initial sensations
associated with out-of-body experiences can be startling to the beginner. This is
especially true if you are unprepared for the experience. Many times this
excitement is caused by the intense sensations and sounds that may occur just
before and during separation. Some people become so excited or startled by these
inner sounds and sensations that they immediately think of their physical body.
This causes an instant “snap back” into the physical. The key is to welcome the
unusual vibrations and sounds and to remain as calm as possible.
The second step is to incorporate the habit of automatic self-control. Whenever
you experience any sensations or sounds associated with out-of-body exploration,
immediately begin to encourage these feelings or sounds to expand throughout
your being. For example, if you experience an intense buzzing sound or unusual
vibrational feeling, immediately begin to encourage the sensation or sound to
spread. Focus your complete attention on the enjoyment of your new, higher
vibratory rate. Then, mentally encourage the vibratory sensations or sounds to
immerse your entire being.
The third step is to direct yourself away from your physical body. This is easily
accomplished by a verbal or mental internal dialogue that directs and maintains you
away from your physical body. For example, “I’m floating up, up or “I’m becoming
lighter and lighter . . . or “I’m now moving to my living room (or backyard, or any
other location away from your body).” Any phrase that directs and separates you
from your physical body will be effective. Remember not to think of, or mention,
your physical body in any way, shape, or form. Even random thoughts directed to
your physical body can cause an abrupt return.
The fourth step is to maintain your focus entirely away from your physical body.
The easiest way to achieve this is to temporarily forget about your body and
become completely involved in the new environment you are experiencing. The
success and duration of your out-of-body experience will depend utterly upon your
focus of attention. Thoughts or feelings related to your physical body will instantly
snap you back into it.
Always remember, we are powerful, nonphysical beings currently inhabiting a
temporary vehicle of flesh. Our ability to control our out-of-body experiences is a
natural part of our personal development. Each experience is an exciting adventure
of discovery. In effect, we are exploring and rediscovering our true identity and
home.
Recognizing and Responding to the Vibrational State
Internal vibrations and sounds often indicate an approaching nonphysical
experience. I refer to the inner sounds and vibrations as the vibrational state.
These vibrations commonly begin at the back of the neck and then spread rapidly
through the entire body. They are often accompanied by numbness and a buzzing
or humming sound. According to an extensive national out-of-body study conducted
by Dr. Stuart Twemlow in 1979, 55 percent of the 339 participants reported “a
sense of energy” during their out-of-body experiences. In addition, 50 percent
stated that they felt vibrations in their bodies and 38 percent that they heard noises
in the early stages of their experience. The most commonly reported noises were
buzzing (29 percent), roaring (19 percent), and music or singing (16 percent).
In the beginning it’s helpful to notice any inner signals you experience during sleep
or dreams and as you are waking. Pay close attention to any unusual vibratory
feelings or sounds, even if they are subtle. Many people routinely experience
vibrational sensations and sounds but disregard them as dream-related or as
unexplained physical phenomena.
Your recognition of and response to these sensations and sounds will, many times,
determine how successful your separation process becomes. Some people are so
startled by the sensations and sounds that they think of their physical body. This
causes an instant return to the physical.
Your positive reaction to the initial sensations and sounds associated with out-ofbody
exploration will help you take advantage of every opportunity to separate
from your physical body and experience the ultimate adventure. The more
knowledgeable and prepared you are, the more successful you are likely to be.
Recognizing and responding to the vibrational state is an important step in your
preparation.
The following list may help you identify the inner signals associated with the initial
phases of an out-of-body experience.
• Buzzing, humming, or roaring sounds.
• Unusual tingling or energy sensations.
• Voices, laughter, or your name being called out.
• Heaviness or sinking.
• Numbness or paralysis in any part of your body.
• Weightlessness or spreading lightness.
• Any internal vibrations out of the norm.
• Electrical-like sense of energy.
• Footsteps or other sounds of a person’s presence.
• Internal rocking, spinning, or movement of any kind.
• Arms or legs lifting while you are asleep.
• Surge of energy flowing through your body.
• Any noise out of the norm: wind, engine, music, bells, and so on.
Currently, several theories address the cause and nature of the vibrations
associated with out-of-body experiences. Based on my experience, I believe that
the vibrations are the direct result of the higherfrequency, nonphysical body
separating from (moving out of phase with) the physical body. I’ve reached this
conclusion because the intensity of the vibrations diminishes immediately after
complete separation is achieved. The way we respond to these initial vibrations will
often determine how effectively we separate from the physical body. The following
are some basic guidelines for responding to the vibrational state.
1. Remain calm. The vibrations, sounds, numbness, and catalepsy are a normal
experience.
2. Allow and encourage the vibrations to spread through your entire body.
Remember not to move or think about your physical body; any physical movement
will shut down the vibrational process.
3. As you allow the vibrations to expand, visualize yourself moving away from your
physical body toward another area in your home. This visualization can be
enhanced by mentally directing yourself with a repeated thought: “Now I move to
the door [or any other location away from your body].”
4. After complete separation is obtained, the vibrations will immediately diminish.
At this point, it’s important to focus and maintain your complete attention away
from your physical body.
I have found that being knowledgeable about the vibrational state, recognizing it
and responding positively to it, is one of the keys to controlling out-of-body
exploration. During the first year of my out-of-body experiences, I was often
startled and sometimes even scared by the intensity of the vibrational state. As I
look back, I realize that I learned the hard way. In the seventies little information
was available on this subject, and what was written scarcely mentioned the topic of
vibrations and sounds. After repeatedly experiencing vibrations and buzzing sounds
while sleeping, dreaming, and doing out-of-body techniques, I began to realize that
these strange vibrations were a natural prelude to the out-of-body experience.
These unusual vibrations and sounds were one of the best early indications that I
was ready to separate from my body. After several experiences, I started to enjoy
the vibrations and even began looking forward to them. In retrospect, I realize that
my attitude toward the vibrational state had a major impact on my ability to initiate
and control my out-of-body experiences. As my anxiety concerning the vibrations
and sounds slowly turned to anticipation, my personal abilities increased
substantially.
Eventually, I got to the point where the vibrational state was a welcome friend that
heralded the beginning of an exciting adventure. After more than a year of
struggle, I finally felt comfortable with the entire process. From that moment,
whenever I felt or heard internal sounds, vibrations, voices, or any form of energy
sensation out of the norm, I would immediately encourage the vibrations or sounds
to expand. Then I would visualize myself moving away from my physical body and
toward the bedroom door.
This combination was remarkably successful. I began to recognize vibrations and
sounds during sleep, in dreams, and during meditation. The intensity of the
vibrations and sounds varied; sometimes they were subtle, at other times
overpowering. I also found that if I experienced mild vibrations, I could focus on
them and encourage them to expand and spread throughout my body. For
example, on one occasion I woke in the middle of the night with a slight vibration
at the back of my neck. I closed my eyes, completely relaxed, and focused on the
vibration, encouraging the sensations to grow and move from the back of my neck
to my entire body. Slowly, the vibrations seemed to travel down my spine and then
outward, enveloping my trunk and limbs. After what seemed to be several minutes,
the vibrations hit their peak and I simply willed myself out-of-body by picturing
myself moving to my bedroom door. Within seconds I was standing at the bedroom
door and ready to explore.
This process is completely natural and extremely enjoyable when you become
accustomed to it. In addition, your newfound control and understanding of the
vibrational state give you an expanded ability to take advantage of every possible
opportunity to explore out-of-body. Always remember, the sensations and sounds
of the vibrational state are an important reference point that can go a long way
toward enhancing your abilities to have controlled out-of-body experiences.
The Hypnagogic State
Every day we experience a state of consciousness similar to a twilight between
sleep and full waking awareness. This transition is often referred to as the
hypnagogic state. As we drift off to sleep, we normally experience this as a brief
but conscious dreamlike state. Similar to hypnosis, the hypnagogic state is a highly
creative state of awareness in which our mental imagery is clear and present, much
like a changing movie in our mind. While in this state, we have the ability to exert a
degree of conscious control and can actually use our internal imagery for specific
purposes. For many people, this state is an excellent springboard for out-of-body
experiences.
Creative artists and inventors have used the hypnagogic state to further their work.
For example, Thomas Edison was well known for his daily catnaps. He developed a
technique for maintaining his hypnagogic state while working on his many
inventions. Sitting in a favorite chair, he would use a form of meditation and
relaxation to enter the hypnagogic state. To control this delicate state between
sleep and wakefulness, Edison would hold some ball bearings in his closed hand,
palm down, as his hand rested on the arm of the chair. Directly beneath his hand
he placed a metal bowl. If be drifted off to sleep, his hand would open and the ball
bearings would fall into the metal bowl and awaken him. It’s reported that he would
repeat this technique over and over until he received the inspiration or information
he sought.
Since the hypnagogic state is very similar to deep hypnosis, it can be used
effectively to program ourselves for an immediate or future out-of-body experience.
From now on, as you fall asleep and awaken, begin to notice the transitional state
you pass through every night. For many people, this is especially evident in. the
last minutes of waking awareness as they drift into sleep. The following technique
can be used both when going to sleep and when just awakening.
Consciously begin to recognize the hypnagogic state immediately before drifting off
to sleep. To increase your awareness of the state, it may help to make a verbal or
written request or goal: “I remain aware as I drift to sleep.” As you drift into sleep,
focus your complete attention on the mental imagery that seems to flow in your
mind.
As much as possible, begin to consciously arrange and control the changing mental
images and scenes that appear. Picture yourself floating up and out of your body.
This could be visualized as a hot-air balloon, an airplane, or an elevator moving up,
or you could picture yourself as a floating cloud. Whatever is comfortable and easy
to picture in your mind will work. Flow with the sensations and pictures in your
mind; have fun with the visualization and allow your imagination to take off. As you
remain focused upon the internal imagery, repeat to yourself, “Now I’m out-ofbody.”
The result of this technique is identical to other out-of-body methods. You will
either fall asleep, awaken in the vibrational state, or awaken floating above or near
your body. The key is to remain calm and direct; maintain complete attention away
from your physical body.
At first glance this technique may appear difficult, but in practice it’s simply a
matter of remaining aware as long as possible as we slowly drift into sleep. Our
natural ability to recognize and direct our consciousness is limited only by our
preconceptions. Many of us have never attempted to extend our awareness beyond
waking consciousness; as sleep approaches, we simply surrender to its sensations
and slowly lose consciousness. I hope that from now on, as you drift off to sleep,
you will view the process of “falling to sleep” in a different light. As you experiment
with the hypnagogic state, you’ll find that it becomes preferable to direct your
attention instead of just allowing your mind to fade into unconsciousness. In
addition, as you begin to pay close attention to the imagery you see, you will gain
some interesting new perceptions into yourself: your motivations, passions, fears,
and abilities. When recognized and used properly, the hypnagogic state can be a
powerful and creative tool for extending our perceptions beyond our physical limits.
Just as Edison used this state of consciousness to obtain inspiration for his many
inventions, we can use it to expand our awareness beyond the physical. The
following visualization can be effective for individuals or groups. In my classes, it is
often used as a relaxation and preparation before an out-of-body technique.
PREPARATION TECHNIQUE
Take several deep breaths and completely relax. Close your eyes and begin to
visualize the top of your head opening and a stream of shimmering white, liquid
energy flowing into the top of your head. The liquid feels warm and soothing as it
slowly flows through the top of your head and past your forehead, eyes, and
mouth. Completely relax and feel all your tensions release into the warm
shimmering liquid. Feel the liquid absorb your tensions and your fears. Feel the
warm liquid slowly flow through your head and down your throat. Feel this warm
energy flow through your heart and spread throughout your body. Feel its warmth
and energy as it flows down your back. Feel it absorbing your tension, your pain,
your fears, and your limits as it fills every part of your arms and legs. Feel your
entire body filled with this wonderful, white liquid energy. Feel every cell, every
tissue, organ, and muscle bathe in this warm white liquid. Now feel the liquid
energy become even warmer. Feel it vibrate and become a liquid sponge, a liquid
magnet. Feel it begin to attract and absorb your negative vibrations. Feel it absorb
your feelings of fear and anger; feel it absorb all the attachments to your body.
Vividly feel all your fears, anxieties, limits, and anger being absorbed into this
warm, vibrating liquid energy. Feel the flow; feel it draw your negative vibrations
from your body, your emotions, your mind. Feel it at every level of your being.
See and feel the glowing, warm liquid begin to darken as it absorbs all your
negative vibrations. Feel every cell, every tissue and organ, every energy system in
your body releasing its impurities, releasing its negative programming, releasing its
limits and fear. Vividly feel all your negative vibrations let go and release their
energy into the warm white liquid flowing through you. Feel this at every level of
your being. Feel your emotional walls dissolve. Feel your attachments to your ego
and your body begin to release to the warm liquid energy.
As your negative energies are released into the warm liquid, see the liquid become
darker and darker. Feel it draw the impurities from your body, your emotions, and
your mind. Feel all your impurities released to the liquid. Now visualize valves at
the base of your heels and the palms of your hands. Slowly open the valves and let
the warm brown liquid begin to flow out of your body. Feel all your negative
emotions—your fears and your limits—draining out and away from your body.
Vividly see and feel your negative emotions and vibrations completely drain from
your body.
Feel every part of your inner being, your inner self, become cleaner and clearer as
your negative energies and thoughts flow from your body. As clearly as possible,
see and feel your individual fears, limits, and negative energies release from your
physical, your emotional, and your intellectual body. Feel all your negative energies
flowing out through your heels and hands. Clearly see all your anxieties, limits, and
attachments flowing from your body. Feel how good it is to be purified of your
negative energies. You have never had a complete inner cleansing before, and you
feel totally fresh and pure. You feel light as a feather, free from the dense negative
limits and thoughts that hold you to matter.
Inwardly acknowledge that all your negative energies are flushed forever from your
body, flushed forever from your physical, emotional, and intellectual body. Feel the
pure power of this cleansing as your body and mind are reenergized and completely
purified of all negative programming, limits, and fears. Absolutely know that all of
your negative energies are washed away forever. Deep down, feel your vibration
rate increase; feel how light and airy you are. Feel the joy as you experience your
new, higher vibration, your higher self. Relax and enjoy your higher, finer
vibrations as you grow lighter and lighter and lighter. Feel yourself becoming light
as a feather, just floating, floating effortlessly, as light as a cloud, floating up and
away from your body.
Separation
Much of the current literature on out-of-body experiences indicates that we
automatically float or lift out of our bodies like some form of magic. Based on my
experience and information obtained from more than two hundred people, I believe
this perception is inaccurate. It’s quite common to enter the vibrational state but
not separate from the body. This occasionally happens even to experienced out-ofbody
explorers. It’s unclear why, during the vibrational phase, we sometimes
cannot or will not separate from the physical body. Any number of reasons could be
mentioned: energy or psychological attachments to the physical; fears; vibrational
misalignment; or simply lack of information concerning how to react to the
experience.
I believe that the last-named is by far the most common reason. There are a
number of things you can do to resolve this situation. First, focus and maintain your
thoughts and imagination upon the sensation of moving away from your body.
Visualize or will yourself away from your body. Second, if necessary, ask to detach
completely from the physical; for example, “Now I move to the door.” Third, if this
fails, simply ask for assistance: “I request help to leave my body.” When requesting
assistance, it’s important that you be completely open to receive what you request.
The subject of separation and the vibrational state is of critical importance and
deserving of more emphasis than parapsychologists and writers have given it up to
now. And considering its importance, it should not be overlooked.
Separation Methods
1. Floating out. Since the inner energy-body is weightless by physical standards,
it’s normally quite easy to just float away from your physical body. This separation
method appears to be the most widely used. The key is to focus on the sensations
of floating and allow yourself to drift up and away from your body.
2. Sit up and out. This method is similar to the floating technique, except that we
simply sit up and then step away from our physical body. It is the primary method I
used during the first ten years of my out-of-body experiences. Because of the
method’s physical-like qualities, it is generally easier to control than the floating or
direct method. This type of separation is often heralded by the vibrational state. I
believe the relatively slow withdrawal from the physical body experienced with this
method creates the intense vibrations and sounds so often reported.
3. Rolling out. This method is extremely effective. After you recognize the
vibrational state, you simply do a sideways roll. As weird as this may sound, it gets
to be fun. Several people have told me that they rolled off the physical bed and fell
to the floor laughing to themselves. This method is used effectively by many
people; author Robert Monroe states in his book Far Journeys that he often uses a
rolling technique when separating from his first energy-body and moving to his
second energy form.
4. Requesting separation. When you enter the vibrational state, simply ask to
separate: “I separate now” or “I move to the next room.” Any firm request that
directs you away from your physical body will be effective. As in all nonphysical
requests, make it a firm demand for immediate action. Always remember to
maintain your complete attention away from your physical body; any thought or
word relating to your body will instantly return you to it.
5. Pulling yourself out. This can be achieved by reaching out your nonphysical
arm and grabbing any large object, then literally pulling the rest of your energy-self
out of your physical body. This method can get interesting because you quickly
learn that your inner energy-body does not share the limits of your physical body.
In other words, our energy-body has the ability to conform to our thoughts. I
accidentally discovered this about ten years ago when I entered the vibrational
state while sleeping in a canopy bed. Stretching my energy arm out in front of me,
I spontaneously decided to try an experiment and attempted to grab the top of the
bed. To my surprise my arm stretched over five feet and I took hold of the top of
the bed. At that point, I pulled my entire nonphysical body out of my physical body.
After standing, I stared at my hand; it had returned to its normal physical size.
Amazed, I recognized that my nonphysical arm’s shape and form completely
depended on my thoughts. This realization is important because it allows us to
expand our abilities in several creative ways.
6. Direct method Commonly called direct or instantaneous projection, this
technique is more advanced than the others— often you find yourself fully
conscious in a completely new environment. The sudden transition from lying in
bed to standing or floating in a different location can be startling if you are
unprepared. Generally, there is little or no sense of movement, just an instant
realization of awakening in a completely new location or environment. This type of
separation is often reported during dream conversions. It is the preferred method
of many experienced out-of-body explorers.
7. Requesting assistance. Sometimes, for reasons unknown, separation can
become more difficult. Several years ago when I was experiencing some difficulty, I
found a simple way to resolve it. I entered the vibrational state and was ready to
lift out, but for some reason my energy-body felt attached and heavy. Out of
desperation I reached out my arm and verbally asked for help. Within seconds I felt
the grasp of a hand pulling me out of my body. The feel of the hand was
surprisingly solid and real. When I left my physical body, I eagerly looked around
but could see no one.
During my workshops, several people have related similar stories of assistance.
Because of this and other evidence, I believe that it’s likely that every time we have
a fully conscious out-of-body experience, someone close to us is observing our
progress. This observer, whether it be a guide, friend, or loved one, is ready to
assist if needed. I’m certain that help is available to us at all times, but it is up to
us to request the assistance. Without such a request, a spiritual friend or guide is
normally not going to interfere with our developmental experiences. I also think
that guides stay out of sight because they know that their visible presence would
disrupt our natural progress. Looking back, I wish I had asked for assistance more
often. I probably would have progressed faster, but more important, I think I would
have appreciated the fact that we’re not alone during our explorations. An
unmistakable feeling of comfort and security comes from knowing that we have
assistance available any time we ask for it. This knowledge helps us to successfully
confront any fear or anxiety we may experience when exploring a new energy
environment.
Action
When you look back on your life, has procrastination ever carried you closer to a
goal or an achievement? Has inaction ever brought you increased success,
accomplishment, or personal development? We are all creatures of habit. We repeat
the same familiar thoughts and actions because they are familiar, unchallenging,
and considered safe. We simply follow our individual path of least resistance. For
many of us, our tendency to remain the same has become a central element of our
personal habits and our life. Many of us consider change—any change—a negative
experience. It is clouded with suspicion and treated as a threat to our established
thought patterns and beliefs. The end result is often a continuation of our personal
habit of inaction. We must eventually ask ourselves whether we are completely
content to live our entire life following the same habits of thought and action. Are
you content to accept blindly, without verification, the prevailing ideas and
convictions of your society? Are you truly satisfied to settle for beliefs, hope, and
faith instead of personal experience and knowledge?
Ask yourself, what would you believe in today if you had been born in Iran or Iraq.
What religious and social convictions and conclusions would you hold dear? What
beliefs would you die for? If you want answers to the mysteries of your life, then
the time for action is now, and out-of-body exploration can provide the answers
you seek.
CHAPTER 6
Exploration Techniques
Genius means little more than the faculty of perceiving in an unhabitual way.
—William James
Today millions of people are discovering the techniques used to achieve out-of-body
exploration. The variety of methods available is staggering. Throughout history,
practically every religious group and mystic order has developed a system or
method to explore beyond the limits of matter. Many of these gems of wisdom have
remained shrouded in mystery for thousands of years, covered by the trappings of
religious ritual. For example, the Tibetan Book of the Dead provides preparation
and guidance for an ancient out-of-body method, but because the technique was
incorporated in lengthy religious ceremonies performed over a period of days, it,
like many other ancient techniques, has remained hidden for centuries. To simplify
this confusing and often misunderstood body of information, I have divided out-ofbody
techniques into five categories: visualization, dream conversion, affirmations,
hypnosis, and sound. The methods I discuss here have proved to be extremely
effective and easy to learn.
The visualization techniques are presented first because of their ease and
popularity. Many people have discovered that the visualization techniques are a
natural way to initiate their first out-of-body experience,
After you select a technique, repeat it daily for at least thirty days. Your
commitment, desire, and effort will determine the results you experience.
Always remember, the best way to approach out-of-body exploration is to maintain
a playful attitude. Have fun with the techniques and enjoy the results.
Choosing Your Technique
One of the most important decisions you face in out-of-body exploration is the
selection of the technique on which to focus. In general, if you can visualize well,
concentrate on the visualization techniques. Select the technique that is most
comfortable for you and stick with it. If you have difficulty visualizing, then you
may want to concentrate on the affirmation techniques. Keep in mind, though, that
the target technique (a form of visualization) has proved effective for many people
who claim poor visualization skills. I believe its effectiveness owes to the physical
“walk-through,” which can be repeated until the internal imagery begins to appear.
Many people find it easier to visualize an object or location in their home than
anywhere else. Don’t underestimate your abilities; when you are open-minded to
new experiences and perceptions, they will occur. On many occasions during my
workshops, people have told me that they can’t visualize at all. I have found that
when people verbally request the ability and begin to practice with an open mind,
they experience a rapid enhancement of their natural abilities. When choosing your
technique, remember to be both flexible and patient.
Visualization
One of the easiest and most effective methods of experiencing out-of-body
exploration is to use your creative visualization ability. Each of us possesses the
natural ability to picture an object or place in our minds. We do it every day in a
thousand different ways. Most of us have little difficulty imagining our favorite
vacation spot, automobile, home, or person. Using our visualization ability is easy
once we recognize how natural it is. To learn just how easy visualization can be, try
the following.
Close your eyes and begin to picture your favorite vacation spot. Select a place you
have visited and know well. Just relax and begin to visualize this vacation area as
clearly as possible. Begin to picture the trees, the buildings, the people—all the
small details associated with your vacation. Become involved in the scene as much
as possible, vividly seeing and hearing all the sensations associated with your
favorite vacation. You can add people, colors, and sounds as you see fit. Now take
this scene a step farther and picture yourself entering your favorite vacation
paradise. Clearly see and feel yourself within a specific physical location. Imagine
all the colors, sounds, and sensations associated with the location. Begin to interact
with the people and environment you see. As much as possible, use all your
senses; immerse yourself in the sounds, sights, and sensations of your vacation.
Take your time and enjoy the experience.
Visualization techniques are easy and enjoyable when you relax and select a
pleasurable place, person, or object on which to focus. Whatever you select as the
focus of your attention, it should be an actual physical object or location. The key to
all out-of-body visualization methods is to become mentally immersed in a real
physical environment. The more focused your attention, the more success you will
experience.
IMAGINATION
Your imagination is your preview of life’s coming attractions.
—Albert Einstein
One of the most powerful tools we possess in out-of-body exploration is our natural
ability to use our imagination. When used creatively, the imagination can help us
achieve any goal or desire on which we focus. This is graphically displayed all
around us. When we look at our physical possessions, we discover an amazing
thing: everything we possess—our car, furniture, home, stereo, TV, even our
relationships—was once imagined in our mind. For example, when you see a house
being built, just think of the many imaginations that were busy creating the
structure. First, some people begin to imagine a new home for themselves, then
they share their ideas with others. Next an architect is called upon to put the
imagined ideas on paper. Then a builder imagines the construction of the home.
Slowly, the collaboration of several imaginations and thoughts comes together to
form an idea, a plan, a structure, and, finally, a physical home. Of course, we take
this for granted, seeing only the physical results of these busy thoughts around us.
When we explore the nonphysical interior of the universe, however, an amazing
thing occurs: we begin to recognize that our imagination and thoughts have a
dramatic impact upon the finer energy frequencies of the inner dimensions. We
begin to understand that our imagination is a powerful creative force that shapes
the unseen energy around us. When we are out-of-body, our thoughts and
imagination are forming our immediate energy environment with incredible speed
and precision. In a very real sense, our thoughts are building the unseen energy
substructure 1 of our external physical existence.
While living in the physical world we see only a tiny fraction of reality. We observe
only the dense results of our thoughts and deeds. The pure power of our
imagination and thoughts is often not recognized as we focus upon daily survival
and the acquisition of physical objects. For many people, the time span between
the imagined idea and the physical results is a long, hard road. They seldom see or
understand that they have formed the subtle energy molds and structures that
have eventually manifested within their physical environment. Whether we realize it
or not, our imagination is molding the subtle energy around us. With every thought,
we are building our future. This is why creative visualization and positive thinking
work so effectively.
The greater the focus of our imagination, the faster the results we experience.
I cannot emphasize enough how important this creative process is to our existence.
It is not some hypothetical belief or theory but an absolute, observable energy
reaction constantly occurring around us.
We can personally verify this by practicing the techniques presented in this book.
This creative energy reaction is constantly at work shaping the subtle energy
around us. For example, an accurate psychic reading is nothing more than the
psychic being sensitive to the unseen energy forms around another person. This
process is not some strange or mystical event, as some believe, but a simple
recognition of the subtle energy forms close to a person. In fact, the entire
phenomenon of extrasensory perception is actually the natural process of people
being sensitive to nonphysical thought-energy and forms. As we evolve, our
recognition of this energy reaction becomes more important. Our innate ability to
structure our energy environment and our life carries us beyond the animal
instincts into new realms of personal creativity and responsibility. The end result is
that each of us becomes the creative artist of his or her life. Each focused thought
and mental image becomes the creative mold of our personal reality. At this point
we can begin to consciously build the reality we wish to experience by the thought
forms we visualize and hold in our mind. Instead of being the powerless result of
our environment, we begin to take charge of our life and our destiny. Finally, we
come to recognize that our ability to create is limited only by our ability to imagine.
One of the advantages of the visualization method is the variety of possibilities it
generates. There are no limitations, so feel free to develop and use your own
technique. Generally, whatever holds your interest and attention away from your
physical body can be effective. For many people, visualizing their favorite friend,
lover, or physical location as they fall asleep produces impressive results. For
example, I know a housepainter who induces out-of-body experiences by
visualizing himself climbing a ladder and painting his home. The key, he states, is
to picture himself at a specific physical location as he drifts off to sleep. In as much
detail as possible, he actually feels the hand-over-hand of climbing up a ladder to
the roof. He feels the grip and texture of the ladder with his hands and can even
feel the ladder slightly shake with each step. He then imagines himself painting his
house with as much vivid detail as possible. As with all visualizations, his technique
is most effective when he surrounds himself in the sensations and sounds
associated with the activity.
VISUALIZATION MADE EASY
The key to out-of-body exploration is to focus and maintain your complete attention
outside your physical body as you fall to sleep. One of the easiest ways to
accomplish this is to focus your complete attention upon a person, place, or object
located some distance from you. This can be a loved one from whom you are
separated, your favorite vacation spot, or a gift that holds special meaning for you.
Whatever you select, it should be an actual physical object you know, not an
imaginary place or person. Select the object or place that is easiest to visualize and
holds the most interest for you. For many, visualizing a loved one is effective. Just
picture the person you wish to be with as vividly as possible. It helps to be
emotionally involved, so select a person you would love to be with. Choose
someone you know, not a fantasy relationship. Become completely absorbed in that
person’s presence and actually feel yourself with him or her. If you like, role-play
some kind of interaction to keep you involved.
Continue your visualization of this person for as long as possible as you allow your
physical body to completely relax and fall to sleep. It’s important to maintain a
detailed picture of the person and your interaction as you go to sleep. As you doze
off, attempt to boost your emotional and visual connection with this person as
much as possible. This method is an excellent bedtime visualization. Keep in mind,
the more emotionally involved you are, the more effective this technique is. Have
fun with it and let your imagination go wild.
THE TARGET TECHNIQUE
Your ability to focus and maintain your awareness away from your physical body is
enhanced if you direct your full attention to a specific object or place. The target
technique is an excellent exercise to help you develop this ability.
Select three targets in your home. All three targets should be physical items that
you can visualize with relative ease. Your targets should not be in the room that
you normally use for your out-of-body techniques. For example, you could select
your favorite chair for your first target. For your second, select a gift that holds a
special meaning for you. Third, select the most visually stimulating object available,
such as your favorite painting, sculpture, or crystal. All three targets should be in
the same room.
After selecting your targets, physically walk to each one and examine every detail.
Study each object from different perspectives, noticing any imperfections or
irregularities. Take your time with the objects, memorizing the sight and texture
associated with each target. Become aware of all your senses during your walk,
especially your senses of sight and touch. Repeat your walk several times until you
can easily recall the smallest details of each target area. Pay close attention to
everything, including colors, weight, densities, reflections of light, coolness, and
heat. Also feel and memorize the sensations associated with your walk from one
target to another. In other words, get into it! Enjoy all the sensory input that you
receive.
This technique helps you focus and maintain your attention away from your
physical body as you drift off to sleep. If you are persistent, the results will be
dramatic. To enhance this exercise, take your time and repeat your physical and
visual walk-through daily for thirty days. Get interested and involved in each target.
This technique is a great way to increase your concentration and visualization skill,
and it only takes about twenty minutes to perform. It’s important to select targets
that are easy for you to visualize. Many people select personal items that possess a
sentimental attraction. Once you make a selection, stay with it; the repetition of
your visualization dramatically increases its effectiveness. This technique has been
my personal favorite ever since I stumbled upon it over twenty years ago when I
began to visualize objects in my mother’s home. I strongly believe that the
technique can work for anyone who is willing to invest the time and effort. The key
is to select target objects that are easy to visualize but interesting enough to hold
your attention. Items that you have made, such as a painting, a sculpture, a silk
flower arrangement, or even a set of curtains, can be extremely effective targets.
As you progress with this technique, you can increase the number and variety of
the targets you select. After you become comfortable with a few objects, you can
expand your visualization to include an entire room. This technique is extremely
effective, but it is up to you to take the steps. The time you invest will be richly
rewarded.
In addition to the targets mentioned above, you may want to consider some of the
following objects to focus on during your visualizations.
Sense of Sight
A favorite chair, sofa, or other piece of furniture
Any object that you can visualize well
A gift or personal item that holds a special meaning
Any object or artwork that you have created yourself
A special picture, painting, or portrait
Sense of Touch
Textured fabric or cloth of any kind
An item of furniture
A door, carpet, light switch, sculpture, or wooden banister
Jewelry, ashtray, candle
Any object that has a unique or distinctive shape or texture
Sense of Smell
Air freshener
Fresh flowers
Soaps or lotions
Favorite perfume or cologne
Cedar chest or closet
Incense
THE MIRROR TECHNIQUE
The mirror technique is an effective way to enhance your visualization skills and
prepare yourself for out-of-body exploration. Begin by placing a full-length mirror in
the room you have selected for out-of-body exploration. The mirror should be
positioned so that you can easily see your entire reflection without having to move
physically. As you look into the mirror, begin to study and memorize your image.
Become as objective as possible: view your reflection as an object you are about to
paint in your mind. Pay close attention to the small details of your body and
clothing. Take your time, memorizing everything you see. Close your eyes and
begin to visualize yourself in as much detail as possible. Continue to repeat this
procedure until you can clearly visualize yourself on the other side of the room.
With your eyes closed, visualize yourself standing on the opposite side of the room.
Then begin to picture your imaginary self. Take your time, slowly moving your
image’s fingers and hands, then slowly beginning to move its arms. Visualize your
reflection moving its toes, feet, and legs. As much as possible, become mentally
and emotionally involved in your reflection. Begin to feel the sensations of
movement you are experiencing. Feel the enjoyment of movement without a
physical body. Become completely involved and immersed in the movements.
As you become more deeply involved in your image’s movements, feel yourself
stand up and slowly begin to walk around the room. As you are walking, feel all the
sensations associated with your movement.
Begin to feel and picture yourself opening your imaginary eyes. As clearly as
possible, feel your image looking around the room. At first, this may feel as if
you’re pretending to see your room from a new perspective. That’s fine; just allow
yourself to flow with all the visual sensations you receive. After some practice you
will begin to notice an enhancement in your ability to see beyond the limits of your
body. Take your time and enjoy the various parts of this technique. If you find it
difficult to transfer your sense of sight, focus on your other senses, such as touch,
as much as possible. As you transfer the majority of your perceptions to your
imaginary self, completely forget about your physical body by focusing all your
attention on your new sensations and sight. Completely relax and allow your
physical body to fall asleep. As your body slowly goes to sleep, you will experience
a transition or shift of awareness from your physical to your nonphysical body. As
this occurs, remember to remain calm and enjoy your new ability to perceive. This
technique is excellent for improving visualization skills. Many people are surprised
at how easily they can visualize after a short period of practice. Take your time and
enjoy the results.
Dream Conversion
Dreams are an effective doorway to out-of-body exploration. For many people
dreaming is a natural way to ease their awareness away from their physical state of
consciousness and begin to recognize and experience other states of consciousness.
Since the dawn of civilization, societies and cultures around the world have viewed
dreams as an entryway to a different world. The significance of dreams is portrayed
in humanity’s oldest recorded writings, including the Upanishads, the Bible, the
Egyptian Book of the Dead, and the Koran. From the lavish dream temples of
ancient Greece to the dream therapy techniques of modern psychologists and
psychiatrists, dreams continue to provide valuable insights into our subconscious
mind. If used properly, dreams can act as an effective trigger or signal for out-ofbody
exploration. Some of the most common signals are listed later in this chapter.
One of the best ways to initiate an out-of-body experience is to become aware or
lucid within a dream. This can be accomplished by changing our attitudes toward
our dreams.
First, begin to acknowledge the importance of your dreams in your daily life. Treat
your dreams as valuable insights and messages from your subconscious mind. In
effect, think of them as an actual form of communication, as real as your physical
experiences.
Second, begin a daily dream log. Record every dream you can, even the small
fragments. This should be done immediately upon waking, either by writing or
using a tape recorder. Pay close attention to the feelings, emotions, and sensations
that you experienced during the dreams.
Third, firmly express your desire for increased clarity and awareness within your
dreams. As you drift to sleep, strongly request that your complete conscious
awareness be present in your dreams. Make a firm, verbal commitment to yourself
as you fall asleep that you will recognize, recall, and consciously experience every
single dream.
Fourth, repeat a strong affirmation to yourself as you fall asleep each night. For
example, “As I fall to sleep, I remain aware,” or “Now I have a fully conscious outof-
body experience,” or “I become aware in my dreams.”
When doing your affirmations, make them firm and positive, fully expecting your
request to be granted. As with all out-of-body affirmations, concentrate your full
emotional and intellectual energy into each one. It’s important to focus and
maintain your affirmations as your last conscious thoughts as you drift to sleep.
The transfer of your awareness can occur quickly, so it’s essential to remain calm
and enjoy any changes in your personal perspective, environment, energy, or
location. The following is a dream conversion that I experienced some years ago.
In my dream I was in a pet store. Looking around, I noticed a small hermit crab on
the floor near my feet. As I watched the crab, it jumped five feet straight up in the
air. At first, I was startled and stepped back; then as I watched, it became obvious
that the crab was attempting to get my attention. Again the crab jumped and I
realized that I had to be dreaming. At that moment I said aloud, “I must be
dreaming.” Immediately, I felt a strange tingling sensation in my body and realized
that I’d entered the vibrational state while dreaming. Out of habit I focused my
complete attention on the idea of floating up and out of my physical body. Within
seconds I could feel myself lift from my body and move toward the living room.
This type of dream conversion is easy to achieve if we are willing to recognize and
accept the entire process. The most important element is how we respond at the
moment we become consciously aware within our dream.
Vivid or lucid dreams are not necessarily unconscious out-of-body experiences;
they can be psychological manifestations similar to internal projections. The
unusual or outrageous events in our dreams are creations of our subconscious mind
specifically designed to grab and hold our attention. I have found that once we
make a firm commitment to explore out-of-body, this type of lucid dream becomes
a regular event. In effect, our subconscious mind is doing its best to assist us in
achieving our goal of a conscious out-of-body experience. This, of course, is
another reason why written goals are so vital. The more focused our goals, the
more our subconscious mind is willing and able to assist us. This type of lucid
dream can be literally anything out of the ordinary: unusual surroundings or
people; outlandish colors or shapes; strange buildings, pets, or other animals. I
have found that lucid dreams often manifest as a single strange event in an
otherwise relatively normal dream—any strange, illogical, or inappropriate person,
place, or thing that is obviously out of the norm. For example, a typical family
sedan may become a bright red sports car. A regular home may become a castle. A
household pet may become a lion or an eagle. A single object or event in a dream
may become completely out of place and outrageous: a jumping crab, a talking cat,
a flying dog. Whatever it is, it’s something so psychologically outlandish that it
captures and holds our complete attention.
The key to a successful dream conversion is our conscious recognition and
knowledgeable response to our lucid dream occurrences. Once you recognize a
strange or illogical event, situation, or object within your dream, focus your
attention as much as possible upon the unusual occurrence. Verbally pinpoint the
illogical event within the dream: “I can’t fly,” or “I don’t live in a castle,” or “That’s
strange, my car isn’t red.” As you become increasingly conscious (lucid) within the
dream, verbally acknowledge that you know you are dreaming. Say aloud anything
that will consciously acknowledge your awareness: “I know I’m dreaming,” “I am
awake in my dream,” or “I’m now aware.
The next step is to be ready for the transition or movement of your consciousness
from your dream state to your nonphysical body. Be prepared for a rapid shift of
your awareness. It’s possible that you will wake up in the vibrational state while
still within your physical body or that you will experience yourself out of sync with
your physical body. Remain calm and direct your inner self, your awareness, away
from your physical body. Allow the inner sensations to develop as you continue to
direct your full attention away from your physical body. Focus all your thoughts
upon the idea of moving to another area of your home. It’s essential to maintain
your awareness fully directed away from your physical body; any thoughts of your
body will snap you back within it.
Request clarity anytime your awareness or vision is less than ideal. “I request
complete clarity now” or “Clarity now!” Always make your request a firm, specific
demand for immediate action. This entire process is very natural. Now, more than
ever, I believe that dreams are created and designed to assist us in our personal
development. It is our choice to recognize and use them or to ignore them.
Whatever we decide, our subconscious mind will continue to send its dream
messages to our conscious mind. Maybe the time has come to listen and learn from
the imagery we receive every night in our dreams.
Dream Signals
• Feeling or seeing yourself in or near a vehicle of any kind— an automobile, boat,
or plane, for example. Also, any dream experience involving a vehicle, such as a
space flight or a boating adventure.
• Recognizing a change in your day-to-day environment, such as your home
becoming a castle, palace, or log cabin. Also, any change in the location,
construction, or color of the surroundings.
• Having feelings, sensations, or experiences such as numbness, paralysis, energy
surges, or sounds out of the norm.
• Recognizing any event, situation, or ability that is out of the norm, such as the
ability to fly, float, or move in other unconventional ways.
• Experiencing yourself as falling or sinking. This includes movement up and down
stairs, elevators, and escalators.
• Having any experience in which you and your out-of-body partner are together.
• Being in any environment that changes rapidly (that is, things appear or
disappear quickly).
• Finding yourself in an environment that you can easily manipulate or control.
Exploring a new environment such as a desert, forest, or snow-covered landscape.
• Recognizing a problem or conflict—for example, driving a car down a mountain
and the brakes are useless.
• Recognizing a bridge, tunnel, or opening of any kind. In your dream this opening
may enable you to overcome an obstacle or barrier—a wall or a river, for example.
• Being taught or guided in any way or being with a companion who seems to act
as a guide. Often this companion is next to you but remains out of your vision.
• Meeting with small groups of people in a classroom or conference-room
atmosphere.
• Encountering multiple levels or floors of any kind: parking garages, office
buildings, ships, and so forth.
• Reading a book or computer program that contains unusual or advanced
information.
The following is an example of a conscious dream conversion that one of my
workshop students experienced. It occurred the day after a six-hour workshop.
I lay in bed this morning deciding whether to start my morning or stay there and
relax for a little while longer. It was not long before I drifted off to sleep.
I found myself dreaming I was in a classroom sitting at a desk. There were other
students in the room.
There was a teacher walking around at the front of the room. She had blonde hair
and seemed to be very nice. I was in the room briefly, then found myself at my
parents’ house. At this point, the dream became lucid. I was lying on the couch in
my parents’ living room thinking about out-of-body experiences and made it my
intention to have one. At first I felt some tingling, then some movement. I went
with the flow of it.
Suddenly I found that the upper half of my body was sitting up and away from the
part still lying down.
From my waist down, I was still inside my body. I asked for help to complete the
experience; then the rest of me slipped out of my body and onto the floor. I felt
very heavy and could not get up. Everything seemed clouded and unclear around
me. I remembered what Bill said in class, and I called all my energy back to me. As
soon as I did, I felt light and was able to get up and move around.
I was very excited about my accomplishment. I remember saying: “I did it! I can’t
believe it! This is great!” I wanted to tell someone who would understand. My
brother was in the room lying on the other couch nearby. I went to my parents’
bedroom to tell my mom what I had done and saw my dad walking out of the room.
He seemed to see me but did not say anything. I entered the room and stood by
my mother’s bedside. I was excited to tell her, but she was still sleeping. I was
deciding whether to wake her when someone appeared alongside her in the bed
and told me not to wake her. I agreed. When I opened my eyes, I was back in my
body and the clock said 9:20.
Affirmations
Affirmations have proved their effectiveness over the past twenty years. Today they
are a regular part of self-improvement courses worldwide. An affirmation is
essentially a strong, positive statement about yourself framed in the present tense.
The root word affirm means to “make firm”; it is a method of solidifying a thought
or idea within ourselves. Affirmations should always be formed as a positive
statement; for example, “I am a positive person,’ “I deserve love,” or “I am getting
better and better every minute, every day” are commonly used affirmations. Every
moment of our lives, our minds are flowing with a constant stream of thoughts. Our
thoughts are continuously influencing our physical and nonphysical reality. Our
intellectual, our emotional, and, finally, our physical state of consciousness is the
direct result of our thoughts.
Affirmations allow us to focus our thoughts and counteract some of the negative
ideas we have accepted. The practice of doing affirmations enables us to begin the
process of replacing negative or limiting thoughts with fresh, positive ones. It is a
powerful method for reprogramming ourselves for positive change and personal
success. Affirmations can be repeated silently, aloud, or in writing; they can even
be expressed in the form of a song or rhyme. In out-of-body exploration they are
generally repeated silently, with increasing emphasis on the last few moments
before the onset of sleep. The goal is to be completely focused upon your desire for
an immediate out-of-body experience as you drift to sleep.
For maximum effectiveness, when using affirmations during any out-of-body
technique, it’s important that you do four things.
First, as much as possible, progressively increase the emotional and intellectual
intensity of your last affirmations as you drift to sleep.
Second, continuously repeat the affirmations until you go to sleep. Make your final
thoughts before sleep your most focused out-of-body affirmations.
Third, think of your affirmations as firm personal commitments that you fully expect
to experience, now!
And fourth, as much as possible, feel completely open to receive the immediate
results of your affirmations.
There are an infinite number and variety of possible affirmations; here are a few
examples.
• Now I’m out-of-body!
• I consciously experience an out-of-body journey. Now!
• I enjoy out-of-body consciousness now!
• I remain aware as my body goes to sleep.
• I remain consciously aware as my body falls to sleep.
• I consciously separate from my physical body after it is asleep.
• As my body goes to sleep, I am completely aware of my out-of-body experience.
• Now I have an out-of-body experience.
• Now I separate from my body!
Affirmations can be used to:
• Affirm your clarity of perception when out-of-body. The clarity technique is
basically a strong affirmation for enhanced perception.
• Declare your immediate intentions to experience an out-of-body journey.
• Reduce fear and increase control.
• Enhance the dream-conversion process and memory recall.
• Enhance and reinforce any of the other out-of-body techniques.
• Control thought, both before and during an out-of-body experience.
• Help remove negative or limiting self-concepts and beliefs related to out-of-body
exploration.
• Reprogram your subconscious for success.
• Help you expand your self-concept beyond the physical body.
• Enhance your ability to move away from your physical body during the initial
seconds of a separation. “I move to the other room” or “I float up and away.”
VISUALIZATION WITH AFFIRMATIONS
Affirmations can be combined with other techniques to enhance their overall
effectiveness. They can also be helpful in focusing and maintaining your conscious
attention upon your goal of an out-of-body experience as your body drifts off to
sleep. The following is an example.
Lie on your back and become as comfortable as possible. Close your eyes,
completely relax, and breathe deeply, slowly, and naturally. As you relax, repeat an
affirmation such as “Now I’m out-of-body” or “I now separate from my body in full
awareness.” Continue this affirmation until you begin to get sleepy. As you mentally
repeat this affirmation, begin to visualize a familiar place: a room in your home or
any other place you know well and can imagine with absolute clarity. Now begin to
picture the room in your mind. As vividly as possible, see the details of the room—
feel the carpet under your feet, the fabric of the curtains and furniture. See the
patterns in the wallpaper and feel the texture of the furniture. Notice and explore
the paintings, the books, all the small details. Become absorbed in the details of the
room. Feel yourself walking around the room. Notice how good it feels, how
comfortable it is. As much as possible, use all your senses. Select one item in the
room. Pick it up and feel its texture, its weight. See and feel this object as clearly
as possible. Become completely absorbed in it. Continue your affirmations as you
drift off. The key to this exercise is to maintain your interest outside your body until
your body falls asleep. The combination of affirmations with this visualization is
extremely effective.
EARLY MORNING TECHNIQUE
One of the best times to induce an out-of-body experience is early in the morning
after two or three REM periods (three to five hours) have passed.
During sleep, every ninety to one hundred minutes we begin a dream period called
rapid eye movement (REM) sleep. Our eye movement during sleep is physical
evidence that we are entering a dream or, in some cases, another altered state of
awareness. The scientific correlation between REM periods and out-of- body
experiences is yet to be confirmed; however, reports linking the two are
commonplace. The following technique is highly effective, but it does require a
degree of self-discipline. Many have found the additional effort worthwhile.
Set your alarm for approximately three to four hours of sleep. After you awaken,
move to another area of your home—a recliner or a sofa, for example. As you
become comfortable in your new location, select your favorite out-of-body
technique. Completely relax and begin to do your affirmations, alone or in
combination with your visualization technique.
Repeat your affirmations, first verbally, then silently to yourself. As you become
more relaxed, focus your complete attention upon your affirmations and away from
your physical body. As you drift to sleep, attempt to boost the emotional and
intellectual impact of your affirmations as much as possible. With increasing
intensity, make your last affirmations before sleep a firm personal commitment to
have an immediate out-of-body experience. It’s important that your last thought
before drifting into sleep be your out-of-body affirmations. As you do this, feel
completely open to receive your request immediately.
Remember to focus all your thoughts and emotions into the affirmations. Your
intensity and personal commitment are most important. Using this technique, many
people report an out-of-body experience immediately after they drift to sleep.
If you have the time, this technique can be repeated several times before morning.
During the first few attempts, you may just go back to sleep; however, with
repeated practice, the technique can provide dramatic results. If you are having
difficulty developing your visualization ability, I highly recommend this technique as
your best alternative. It is one of the most powerful methods available and does
not require visualization skills.
I believe the effectiveness of this technique has little to do with the time of day.
What’s really important is your mental state: after three or four hours of sleep,
your body and mind are partially refreshed and completely relaxed. This mindawake
body-relaxed state of awareness is the ideal starting point for any technique
used in out-of-body exploration.
I discovered this technique by accident several years after beginning out-of-body
exploration. One night, after sleeping about four hours, I awakened unexpectedly
and decided to get up and read. On an impulse I started to write some out-of-body
affirmations. After fifteen minutes of writing, I began to feel extremely tired.
Selecting two affirmations, I continued to repeat them to myself as I relaxed on the
sofa. I continuously repeated these affirmations as I drifted to sleep: “Now I have a
fully conscious out-of-body experience. Now I’m out of my body!” I focused all my
energy into each affirmation, exerting every effort to make the affirmations my last
conscious thoughts as I drifted to sleep. The following experience occurred at 3:1 5
A.M., immediately after my physical body dozed off to sleep.
Journal Entry, March 7, 1984
I feel intense waves of energy flowing through me. A sense of movement begins—
extreme, building movement. Instantly, I am at an oceanfront home. All I can hear
is pounding surf. Everything in the large house appears white and fuzzy, so I say
aloud, “Clarity now!” As I look around, forms come into focus. I am standing in
front of a huge oblong table, eighteen feet long. The room is filled with shining
people. They seem to radiate light from every pore of their bodies. Seven men and
one woman come forward to greet me. As the woman approaches, I can see her
smile. When she looks at me, vivid pictures begin to appear within my mind. The
meaning of each picture becomes instantly clear. “It’s good to see you again. You
have been busy.” I can clearly feel the warmth of her thoughts.
The group gathers around the table, and I know it’s time to sit down. As I look
around the room, it seems to expand with my vision, I can still hear the waves
crashing and I wish to see the ocean. A clear picture appears in my mind, “You will
experience the ocean soon enough. Let’s begin.”
I respond automatically, “The ocean sounds beautiful today.”
Soon another thought appears in my mind, “Yes, the ocean is wonderful. We take it
for granted. Our visitors are normally unconscious. We will adapt.” There is a brief
pause, then a continuation of thought-energy from the other end of the room:
“There is much energy being directed into the dense regions. Those who live in the
hard bodies are beginning to respond. There is much to be done. Those who are
awakening from their sleep are searching for answers—searching on the outside.
No wonder there is so much confusion. We know how tough the physical vehicles
can be; we have all been there. The ultimate test is to recognize the truth while
surrounded by dense illusions.”
Spontaneously I respond with a thought, “There is too much expected and too little
guidance provided. Why must it be so hard?”
Another picture appears in my mind. I somehow know it’s female. “The school is
firm, but fair. Each creates the lessons they need.”
I look toward her and my thoughts just seem to flow. “But why so much ignorance
and pain?”
Another voice enters my mind, “School is painful for some, enlightening for others.
Only experience creates wisdom. The end result is always effective.”
I respond, “Even so, too little guidance is provided. Five billion people, and all are
hoping and praying that what they believe is true. It seems like an ineffective
school to me—all these people living in the dark.”
Another voice appears, “You don’t see the whole picture, my friend. Time is an
illusion. There is no rush. All are immortal. The very act of being is experience, and
experience creates wisdom. Time is not the issue.”
As I look around the room, the reality of the experience is overpowering. I can feel
the table and see the room with absolute clarity. Distracted by the sound of the
waves, I begin to feel an intense tugging sensation. I am being pulled back. In
seconds I am within my physical body. As I slowly open my eyes, feelings of
numbness, tingling, and disorientation quickly fade.
Hypnosis
Hypnosis is becoming an increasingly popular self-improvement tool. It is regularly
used in behavior modification therapy for such things as weight control, sports
improvement, stress release, memory enhancement, and the treatment of fears
and phobias. Recently, some powerful new uses for hypnosis have come to light.
One of the most publicized and popular is past-life regression. Regressing patients
to a previous physical life can help them uncover, experience, and resolve a present
problem, fear, or phobia by going to the source of the dilemma. An impressive
number of recently published hypnotic regressions have reported obtaining
verifiable information from past centuries, including names, dates, places, and
events.
During several of the past-life regressions I’ve conducted, I have noticed a
tendency for some of my clients to experience a brief out-of-body state of
awareness, generally during the transition experienced between physical lives.
Additional investigation made it clear that hypnosis could be used to induce a
controlled out-of-body adventure. With minor modifications, the induction
techniques normally used in past-life regression are generally effective in out-ofbody
exploration. The basic hypnotic induction can remain the same; only the
directions after the induction are changed. Hypnosis has provided dramatic benefits
for millions of people in the past decade. Now modern hypnosis can be used to
initiate a self-controlled, out-of-body experience. Its benefits are especially evident
in four major areas. First, hypnosis can effectively induce the ideal mental state for
out-of-body exploration (mind alert/body relaxed). Second, it can assist in the
control, reduction, and elimination of subconscious and conscious blocks, fears, and
limits relating to out-of-body experiences. Third, hypnosis can be used to improve
visualization, concentration, and meditative skills. And finally, hypnotic suggestions
can be effective in triggering a fully conscious out-of-body experience. For example,
the hypnotic suggestions “I become consciously aware during my dreams” and “My
dreams trigger a conscious out-of-body experience” can substantially assist the
dream-conversion process. Suggestions such as “After I enter sleep, I recognize
and experience a fully conscious out-of-body adventure” and “Sleep triggers my
out-of-body experiences” can be used to reinforce and enhance an individual’s
ability to respond positively to his or her out-of-body techniques.
When selecting a trained hypnotherapist, first check qualifications. Many states
require a certification or license. Next, inquire into areas of expertise. (Many
hypnotherapists are specialists in areas such as weight control and eating
disorders.) The ideal choice is someone with an extensive background in pastlife
regression, someone knowledgeable about metaphysics and out-of-body
exploration. Such individuals are generally more familiar with the nonphysical
(thought-responsive) environments encountered when out-of-body. They are also
more adept at dealing with the perceptions and experiences unique to out-of-body
exploration. Often their awareness of metaphysics gives them a greater
understanding of the motivations and goals of people seeking out-of-body
adventure.
SELF-HYPNOSIS
Self-hypnosis is another powerful new tool for self-improvement. Often our fears
and limits are subconsciously programmed within us. Internally we have accepted a
rigid concept of ourselves and placed limits on our abilities. These subconscious
limits are the walls that hold us from our unlimited potential. In a sense we have
built walls around ourselves. One of the most effective ways to dissolve our selfaccepted
limits and fears is to confront them directly. Hypnosis gives us the unique
ability to access our subconscious mind and resolve our fears and limits. In
addition, we can reprogram our subconscious mind for success in any endeavor,
including nonphysical exploration.
The following is a self-hypnosis script that you can tape and use at home. As you
record this hypnosis script, take your time and speak in a relaxed tone. At each
break between phrases, pause for approximately two seconds. Attempt to be
consistent throughout the taping. Many people have a tendency to speed up as
they record, so take your time and relax. Pauses that are longer than a couple of
seconds will be indicated. For the best results, use an auto-reverse tape recorder
and a long-play (ninety minutes or more), high-quality tape.
When doing this self-hypnosis technique, become as comfortable as possible in your
designated out-of-body exploration area. If possible, use a recliner or a comfortable
sofa. Select a time and place that will allow you an hour and a half of solitude. If
needed, temporarily unplug the phone.
NEVER USE A HYPNOSIS TAPE WHEN DRIVING A CAR!
OUT-OF-BODY SELF-HYPNOSIS SCRIPT
Take several deep breaths, allow your eyes to close, and completely relax, Just
allow your body and mind to completely relax.,,, As you feel yourself becoming
comfortable and relaxed . . . release yourself to a special kind of experience, . . .
Let go and relax.,.. Take a deep breath . . . and completely relax, completely relax,
. . . Now, relax even more, . . . Take another slow, deep breath . . . letting go of all
stress . . . all tension. . . . With each breath feel all your tension flowing out of you.
. . . Just relax . . . completely relax, . . . Visualize, imagine, or feel your head
bathed in a soft healing light . . . a light that quiets all thoughts . . . a light that
quiets all worries, . . . Your mind is at peace. . . . This soft, healing light releases
your physical senses from their work, . . . Just feel your head and its senses
enveloped in this light, . . . Now, allow this healing light to expand slightly . . . feel
the light as it slowly moves down your neck and shoulders, . . . Each muscle and
cell that it touches is made more relaxed . . . more centered . . . more harmonized,
. . . No other sounds will disturb you. . . . They will only cause you to go deeper . . .
and deeper. . . . You are more peaceful and relaxed. . . . As this quiet, soft, healing
light envelops your neck and shoulders . . . every nerve cell . . . every muscle is
completely relaxed. . . . Every cell and tissue of your body is completely relaxed. . .
. Now, allow this light to flow even farther. . . . Feel it as it flows down through your
arms . . . your hands . . . your fingers . . . bringing greater relaxation. . . . Feel the
light envelop your chest and your upper back . . . your ribs . . . your internal organs
. . . your lungs . . . and heart. . . . Any tension . . . any stress that is a part of your
body is released as this soft healing light fills you. . . . Now let the light expand
even more until it fills your stomach and lower back, . . . Feel every muscle and cell
relax and release. . . . The warm, relaxing light surrounds and envelops your hips .
. . your legs. . . . As you completely relax, no other sounds will disturb you. . . . All
sounds will only cause you to go deeper . . . and deeper . . . down . . . down . . .
into a more peaceful and relaxed state of being. . . . You are fully relaxed . . . fully
at peace. . . . You feel completely safe . . . completely protected. . . . You can feel
the relaxing power flow into your feet. . . . All the muscles throughout your body
are now completely relaxed.... They are so relaxed, you can’t move them. . . .
Every muscle is so relaxed . . . so. very relaxed. . . . Feel yourself go . . . deeper
and deeper . . . down . . . down . . . deeply relaxed.... . Now you can feel the soft,
relaxing power of the light shining upon you. . . . This warm feeling of the
light is radiating through your entire body. . . . You can feel its warmth . . . feel its
protection, . . . You are surrounded by the relaxing, warm energy of the light, . . .
As you completely and pleasantly relax your entire body . . . you can slow down a
little bit. . . . Just allow yourself to slow down a little bit, and later, as we go, you
can slow down a little bit more and let go. . . . I am going to count downward from
ten to one; with each descending number, allow yourself to slow down and relax . .
. and when I reach the number one, you will enter your own level of deep, deep
relaxation. Ten . . . down, down, nine . . . deeper, deeper, down, eight . . . down,
down, deeper, deeper, seven . . . down, six . . . down, five . . . deeper, four . . .
deeper, down, three . . . deeper, down, two . . . deeper, down, and . . . one. You
are now at a very deep level of natural relaxation, . . . Remember . . . you are in
complete control and are completely aware at every level of your mind. This
journey is something you want, because you are eager to explore, eager to learn, .
. . In a moment we will begin a series of exercises into your perception, your ability
to see and feel and be completely free from your physical body . . . from your
temporary physical vehicle.
Now, feel the part of yourself that longs for something more. . . . There is a part of
you that longs to see more . . . longs for movement, As this longing grows within
you . . . feel this longing grow into a desire . . . a passion to know your true self . .
. to know and experience yourself completely independent of your physical body . .
. to know and experience your spiritual self, . . . Feel this desire. . . . I want you to
look on the horizon and see or imagine a soft light . . . a doorway of light, . . . You
feel and know this light to be good. . . . This light is full of love and protection. . . .
Now begin moving toward this doorway of light, . . . Feel yourself moving toward
the doorway of light, . . . As you see this doorway get closer and closer . . . you can
feel yourself totally enveloped in the light . . . you are totally enveloped and
protected by the light . . . you can feel the warmth and protection of the light, . . .
The light surrounds you and flows throughout your body . . . throughout your entire
being. . . .
Now visualize, imagine, or feel yourself moving through the doorway. . . . And as
you move through the doorway of light, I want you to know that you are moving
away from your physical shell, . . . As you step through this doorway of light . . .
you will view and observe your body objectively . . . knowing at all times that you
are always surrounded in the white light of protection; . . . as soul, you choose to
step from the limits of matter. . . . So, I want you to observe every detail, . . . Now
feel yourself becoming lighter, . . . You are becoming lighter and lighter . . . you are
as light as a feather . . . light as a balloon as you slowly lift and float up, up, up. . .
. Now you can feel yourself floating free. . . . As you float, enjoy all the warm
sensations of floating free . . . floating completely free from your physical body. . . .
You are floating above your body. . . . As you enjoy the floating sensations, you can
feel your awareness increase..., You are more aware . . . more aware of your new,
lighter energy-body . . . more aware of your light energy-self. . . . Now you are
completely aware of your energy-self . . . your floating energy-self. . . . Your entire
awareness is moving into your light energy-self. . . . Joyfully, you
can feel yourself floating free, floating completely free of all limits . . . all dense
limits, . . . Now you are completely aware within your light self. . . . You can see
and feel with all your awareness . . . all your consciousness is within your light
energy-self. . . . You can feel the joy of being free from your physical body,
completely free from all limits, . . . Now, what do you see? . . . What do you
observe?. . . [Pause for fifteen seconds.]
You can feel and see an increase in your new perception, . . . Your vision is
becoming better and better . . . clearer and clearer.,.. Your vision is sharper,
clearer than ever before. . . . Your lighter self now has perfect vision . . . your
lighter self possesses crystal-clear vision . . . perfect perceptions. . . . You can feel
your entire awareness. . . . Your entire consciousness is completely within your
lighter energy-self. . . . You focus all your energy within your light energy-self. . . .
What do you see? . . . What does it feel like? . . . Can you see your body? . . .
Describe what you see in detail.... Enjoy all the sensations and sights. . . . Take all
the time you need. . . . [Pause for three minutes.]
Now, slowly return to your physical body. . . . Take your time and slowly return, . .
. As you return, you absolutely know that you can separate from your physical body
with ease, . . . With complete confidence, you can step from your physical body
whenever you wish, . . . You now know that your physical body is
only a vehicle for your awareness . . . only one vehicle of many that you possess. .
. . It feels good to be able to go beyond your body to see and know for yourself. . .
. From now on, you can and will leave your physical body with complete ease . . .
complete safety, whenever you wish. Now, breathe deeply, relaxed and
comfortable. . . . In a few moments I am going to count from one to three, so that
by the time I say number three, you will be able to open your eyes and feel wide
awake, . . . You will remember all that you have experienced, . . . You will awaken
to even further insight, . . . You will feel invigorated and revitalized, . . . You will be
rejuvenated and rested . . . as though you have taken a peaceful nap. . . . You will
be in complete harmony. . . . You will feel fitter . . . better . . . and maintain a
conscious connection with your inner self. . . . Because you have been able to relax
so deeply and soundly, your mind will be sharp and alert, . . . You will be able to
think more clearly and creatively, . . . We’ll begin, . . . One. . . . You are feeling
very rested now, . . . Your entire body is very much at peace. . . . You have been
able to relax deeply and soundly, and this ability has enabled you to transcend your
physical body. . . . In the future you will find that each session will be even more
relaxing and even more rewarding. . . . Two. . . . You begin to feel energy and life
flowing to every part of your body now, . . . You feel full of energy and vigor, . . .
You remember all that you have experienced . . . and even more insight will reveal
itself in the days ahead. . . . You feel alert and awake, . . . You have a deep feeling
of well-being and knowledge. . . . You feel sound . . . healthier . . . ready to take on
whatever may come your way. . . . You feel refreshed and rested as though
awakening from a long nap. . . . Three.... Your entire body, mind, and soul are
refreshed, . . . Now open your eyes feeling completely refreshed and full of energy
and joy.
Sound
The use of sound to induce out-of-body experiences dates back thousands of years.
The Tibetan monks are famous for their use of chants, chimes, and bells to enhance
their meditative states. In the last two decades, chanting and mantras have
become a well-established part of meditation classes in the West. The repetition of
certain sounds is an ancient practice widely known and accepted today as an
effective method of enhancing an individual’s focus of attention.
SOUND-FREQUENCY TECHNIQUES
The practice of using sound frequencies to induce out-of-body experiences has not
been widely investigated by the scientific community. Currently, the most extensive
research is being conducted by the Monroe Institute of Applied Sciences, located in
Nelson County, Virginia. For over twenty years, the institute’s founder and
executive director, Robert Monroe, has experimented with the potential of soundinduced
altered states of awareness. In recent years, the Monroe Institute has
developed some practical methods to accelerate learning through enhanced states
of consciousness. These methods incorporate a system of audio pulses that create a
frequency-following response in the human brain. The result is a synchronization of
the brain’s left and right hemispheres.
One of the institute’s goals is to provide practical assistance for individuals who are
interested in exploring the nonphysical dimensions of the universe. Toward this end
it has created a series of audiotapes called Hemi-sync. The tapes are designed to
feed a 1 00-hertz frequency signal into one ear and a 1 04-hertz frequency into the
other ear; the 4-hertz difference represents the predominant brain frequency at the
moment of an out-of-body experience. Even though sound-frequency techniques
are still relatively new, I’m certain that with continuing research and development,
this revolutionary form of out-of-body induction will become commonplace in the
near future. To introduce you to sound-frequency techniques I have included an
ancient method used by Tibetan monks. This is one of the oldest out-of-body
techniques, dating back a thousand years before the birth of Christ.
SOUND TECHNIQUE
Take several deep breaths and completely relax. Become comfortable in your
designated out-of-body area. Close your eyes and begin to focus your attention just
above the crown of your head. Concentrate all your awareness above your head
until the sensations of your body begin to disappear. As your physical sensations
begin to fade, softly intone the sound OM seven times. Let the sound resonate
through the top of your head. Repeat the OM sound in your mind seven times. Be
completely aware of the sound resonating in your mind. Let the sound rise through
the top of your head. Focusing all your attention on the very core of the resonance,
allow the sound to slowly ascend toward the ceiling. Feel your awareness merging
with the sound. As much as possible, become one with the rising sound, as your
body becomes increasingly relaxed. Feel your awareness rising with the sound.
Become one with the OM resonance. Enjoy the sound, and flow with it. Feel
yourself become lighter and lighter as you float with the sound. Allow your physical
body to rest and sleep as you focus all your attention on the rising sound. Maintain
all your attention on the rising sound as your body falls to sleep. As you begin to
fall asleep, concentrate all your awareness on the rising sound.’
This technique can be effectively used with an out-of-body induction sound tape.
When using any external sound system, remember to focus on your internal
sounds. The external sound’s only purpose is to reinforce and enhance your own
voice.
Repetition (Ceremonial Technique)
On numerous occasions people have told me of creating a repetitive system or
ritual for their out-of-body preparation. Essentially, they have created a personal
series of repetitive events that lead up to their out-of-body experiences. For
example, they may take a long relaxing bath, then wear a special white robe and
place lighted candles around their bed or sofa as they prepare to relax and begin
their out-of-body technique. Throughout this process, they constantly focus upon
their desire for an immediate out-of-body experience. Many people report
impressive results with this kind of approach.
I believe the success of the ritual technique owes to the special emphasis given to
the goal during the entire preparation procedure. The mind registers the rather
lengthy, repetitive process as something special and focuses additional
subconscious attention upon the specified goal—an out-of-body experience.
Moreover, the very act of repeating the same procedure for a period of weeks has
an impact on the subconscious mind. There’s an old saying that any act or thought
repeated daily for twenty-one days becomes a habit. This idea is based on the
premise that our subconscious mind takes note of the daily repetition and accepts it
as a new behavior norm. I believe the same principle explains why daily repetition
and the ritual technique are so effective.
Looking back over the years, I now recognize that I created my own ritual-like
procedure. In the early seventies for a period of two years I woke up at 7:00 A.M.,
went to a morning college class at 8:30, then returned around 11:30 and relaxed.
Every day at noon I would lie in bed on my back and do an out-of-body technique.
This process was extremely effective. After several weeks of daily repetition, I had
programmed myself to have out-of-body experiences. After several months, I didn’t
need to do a technique of any kind; I would just take a nap at noon and
automatically lift up and away from my physical body. In retrospect, I believe that
this was a form of self-conditioning. Success builds upon success, and once my
conscious and subconscious mind accepted the process of out-of-body experiences,
it became a very natural state of being. After I had had several successful and
enjoyable experiences, my subconscious mind began to fully cooperate with my
desires.
This is important because it points the way to a deeper understanding of the entire
process of out-of-body exploration. To obtain the knowledge and wisdom available
to us within the nonphysical dimensions of the universe, we must go beyond our
superficial desires. To become proficient at nonphysical exploration, we must be
willing to program ourselves for success. Halfhearted attempts at out-of-body
techniques will produce halfhearted results. For real success and control, we must
be willing to make a full emotional and intellectual commitment to this exploration.
The easiest way to do this is to create a daily repetition or ritual of preparation and
technique. The key is to do it daily and, if at all possible, at the same time and
place. The combination of repetition and determination creates a powerful system
of success that can be used to achieve whatever you may desire out of life.
Results Commonly Reported
The initial results reported during out-of-body experiences vary from person to
person. Over the past twenty years, however, I have noticed some remarkable
similarities. How we react to the initial changes we experience will many times
control our success. The rapid transfer of your personal awareness from your
physical body to your nonphysical self can be a startling leap if you are unprepared.
Having some idea of what to expect will greatly assist your initial explorations. The
more prepared you are for the experience, the greater the control you will be able
to exercise. Your positive response to the sudden change of your personal location,
perception, and viewpoint is absolutely essential to a successful controlled
experience.
As you focus all your attention upon your out-of-body technique, your physical
body will become increasingly relaxed. Eventually your body will begin its transition
into sleep. As this sleep transition occurs, you may experience a dramatic change in
your normal sleep cycle. This change may occur immediately after your body goes
to sleep or during a REM period. It is during this transition that the inner signals are
reported most often, so pay attention to any unusual internal sounds or sensations
you may experience.
The following are the most commonly reported results experienced immediately
after an out-of-body technique.
1. Floating, standing, or lying just outside your physical body.
2. Experiencing your energy-self either lying or sitting within your physical body.
This may be accompanied by an intense vibration circulating through your entire
energy-body. You may feel out of sync with your physical body and ready to simply
“lift out” of the physical. This is completely natural; just focus your attention on
your new vibration rate and direct yourself to move away from your physical
vehicle.
3. Standing or sitting at one of your target areas observing your new environment.
This shift of awareness is rapid, so remain calm and enjoy your new vibration rate.
4. Experiencing a lucid dream (a dream in which you become consciously aware of
your environment). During this dream, you may experience one or more of your
inner signals. Focus your attention on the vibration or sound and will yourself away
from your body.
5.Experiencing a nonphysical environment that differs from your daily
surroundings. Remain calm and enjoy your new environment.
An Overview of the Ideal Mind-Set
• Begin with a clean slate. As much as possible, release your preconceptions, limits,
beliefs, and convictions. Picture yourself starting your life again, completely free of
self-conceptions and limits.
• Trust yourself and your abilities. You are a spiritual being possessing creative
abilities and can easily separate from your temporary physical body.
• Be open to receive. Completely open to a new perception of yourself, an
expanded vision of yourself possessing unlimited capabilities.
• Be open to recognize and release any personal barriers, blocks, or perceptions
that limit your growth and development.
• Be open to recognize and release the intensive indoctrination and conditioning
that you have received.
• Be open and receptive to a change in your awareness. Welcome a fully aware
shift of your consciousness from your dense vehicle and limits to your higher
energy-self.
• Strongly feel your inner self urging you to explore and experience beyond your
dense physical vehicle.
• Focus all your energy, attention, and desire on your personal commitment to
recognize and experience yourself independent of your physical vehicle.
• Throughout every cell, every tissue, every part of your being, absolutely know,
absolutely feel that you are a high-energy, nonphysical being. Because you are
more than matter, you consciously separate from your dense physical vehicle with
ease.
• Feel totally safe, secure, and protected to step from your physical vehicle now.
• Fully recognize and acknowledge that the ideal environment and time for your
out-of-body exploration is today. Now!
• Release and detach yourself from the earth. Vividly see yourself unhook from
your body, setting you free from your physical limits.
• As you practice your favorite out-of-body technique, repeat the following
affirmation: “I am more than a physical body. Because I am more than matter, I
now separate from my physical body with full awareness.”
Techniques Review
1. Remain calm. Internal vibrations, sounds, and motion are normal experiences.
2. Be fearless, for you are protected and immortal.
3. Demand complete clarity of your awareness, “Clarity now!” as often as
necessary.
4. Focus and maintain your thoughts away from your physical body at all times.
5. Focus upon a specific desired objective: a person, place, or state of
consciousness that you would like to experience.
6. Be prepared for a sense of motion after making a request.
7. Enjoy your new explorations. The unseen universe is your birthright and destiny.
Basics of Out-of-Body Exploration
1. We are spiritual (nonphysical energy) beings temporarily using biological bodies
(vehicles) for experience and expression.
2. Since the physical body is a temporary vehicle, it is only natural for us to be able
to separate from it and experience our true nonphysical self.
3. We are currently experiencing a biological vehicle so that we can explore,
interact, and learn within the physical dimension.
4. Out-of-body experiences are the normal shift or transfer of awareness from our
physical vehicle to our higher-frequency nonphysical body.
5. We are simultaneously using and controlling multiple energy (frequency)
vehicles. Each of these energy vehicles exists at a distinctly different density and
vibrational frequency. Ideally, all our energy vehicles work in harmony to assist in
our personal development.
6. Each individual vehicle of consciousness perceives within its unique frequency of
the universe. To perceive and experience matter, we must have a vehicle of matter.
To consciously perceive and experience the higher (less dense) vibratory
dimensions, we must consciously be using the appropriate energy vehicle.
7. We are the creative source of our reality and our experience. We create our
individual reality by the way we focus and manage our personal thought-energy.
This principle applies to all energy levels of the universe. What we experience has
been influenced, arranged, and manifested by our conscious and subconscious
thoughts.
CHAPTER 7
Mastering the Experience
Every man takes the limits of his own field of vision for the limits of the world
—Schopenhauer
If we are to obtain the maximum benefits available during an out-of-body
experience, control is an absolute necessity. The key to effective nonphysical
exploration is the conscious control of our nonphysical state of awareness. Once a
degree of control is achieved, the potential of out-of-body exploration becomes
absolutely unlimited. In fact, our imagination is inadequate to conceive of all the
available possibilities. Experience has taught me that the more prepared we are for
our explorations, the more effectively we can maneuver and adapt within the
nonphysical environments. After proper preparation, many people report a high
degree of control even during their first experiences.
Physical concepts and energy laws have little bearing within the nonphysical
dimensions of the universe,
To be truly effective when out-of-body, we must learn the nonphysical “rules of the
road.” To prepare and assist you, I have compiled an overview of situations,
events, and challenges that you may encounter in your out-of-body explorations
(see table below). This information is the result of my personal experience and
feedback I’ve received from hundreds of people who have had out-of-body
experiences over the last twenty years. I have found that much of the published
information currently available is inadequate; it is either limited to a single
viewpoint or slanted by religious beliefs and interpretations. With that in mind, I
have presented this overview with as little cultural bias as possible.
In a world overflowing with beliefs and theories, there is a tremendous need for
practical information obtained from firsthand experience. I have come to realize
that the answers to the mysteries of our existence are not hidden; they are
patiently waiting for us to extend our vision beyond the dense limits of matter. The
keys to control will assist you in this quest.
Keys to Control
Situation Key to Control
Inner vibrations (sometimes intense)
accompanied by loud buzzing, humming, or
roaring sounds.
You are experiencing the vibrational state.
Immediately direct your full attention away
from your physical body.
Catalepsy (inability to move your physical
body)
This is a normal, temporary your physical
body). phenomenon that may occur
immediately before or after an out-of-body
experience. Your higher-frequency energybody
is temporarily out of sync with your
physical body.
Unintentional return to your physical
body.
Normally caused by random thoughts directed
toward your physical body. You must maintain
your full attention within the nonphysical
environment and energy-body that you are
experiencing.
Blurred vision; unclear or dreamlike
awareness.
Firmly request clarity until your vision or
awareness is clear: “Clarity now!” Then
focus on a specific item or area in the
environment you are exploring.
Feeling of fear or anxiety; panic attack. Repeat to yourself that you are safe and
secure. Surround yourself with an
impenetrable wall or globe of protective white
light. (Refer to text for additional information.)
Tunnel experience. This occurs when the energy membrane
dividing two major frequency levels
(nonphysical energy dimensions) opens.
Movement through a tunnel is often
experienced as an intense inward motion.
Remain calm; the sense of rapid movement
will normally cease in seconds. The end result
will be your entrance into a different energy
dimension or environment.
Sensation of rapid inner movement;
experience of being drawn deep within
unknown areas of yourself.
This motion is often intense and can be
startling if you are unprepared. Remain calm;
this is a normal shift of consciousness from
your denser energybody to a higher-frequency
form.
Heaviness or inability to move freely
just after separation.
This is caused by insufficient consciousness in
your nonphysical body. Firmly request that
your complete awareness be present in the
energy-body you are experiencing. Ask for
“Awareness now!” and/or demand lightness
and mobility.
Lack of vivid recall after an experience. Firmly request enhanced recall of your out-ofbody
experience: “I remember all.” This is
especially effective if done when out-of-body.
Experience of being form-less or
shapeless conscious energy.
This is the normal recognition of our true
nonphysical self (soul).
Extremely loud pop or bang (like a
gunshot) close to your head, heard at the
moment of separation from the body.
This sometimes startling sound is likely the
result of a sudden disconnect from a point
located somewhere in the head (the pineal
gland, according to many).
Sensation of looking through your
closed physical eyelids.
This occurs when your consciousness is
transferred within your energy-body but you
have not separated from your physical body.
Simply direct yourself away from your
physical body: “I move to the door.”
Entering the vibrational state but being
unable to separate from your body.
Direct your complete attention on moving
away from your physical body and toward
another area of your home. It’s critically
important to maintain the focus of your
attention away from your physical body at all
times.
Strange or unusual sounds during sleep
(voices, buzzing, bells, humming, music,
footsteps, any sound inappropriate to your
current physical surroundings).
Unusual sounds are indications that your
awareness has already transferred from your
physical to your nonphysical body. I refer to
these sounds as inner signals (see text).
Entering a nonphysical environment
containing cloudlike forms (sometimes
appearing as holographic images with
varying degrees of density).
You are observing nonphysical thought-energy
forms. They are the direct result of focused
thought upon a nonconsensus or natural
nonphysical energy environment.
Your immediate surroundings appear to
duplicate your physical environment.
You are currently experiencing your slowest
frequency (densest) nonphysical energy-body
and observing the parallel energy dimension
closest to the physical universe.
Sensation of being touched while out-ofbody
(sometimes occurs just before or after
separation).
This can be caused by at least three things:
(1) your mind’s interpretation of nonphysical
energy currents;
(2) an energy adjustment of your nonphysical
body; or
(3) a nonphysical inhabitant or loved one
touching you. Generally we are subconsciously
inviting this to occur.
Vivid thoughts or pictures entering your
mind.
Someone is communicating with you. The
universal method of nonphysical
communication is direct thoughttransference.
This could also be a form of communication
with a higher aspect of yourself.
Perceiving or sensing an approaching
form of energy or light.
.
You are recognizing an energy being near you.
This could be any high-frequency being: a
guide, friend, angel, or any interdimensional
inhabitant
Becoming lost or disoriented. Stop all forward motion and request assistance
and/or clarity. Select an item in your
immediate environment and focus upon it.
Entering a new room only to find that the
entire environment has changed.
A common occurrence. Entranceways, doors,
and windows often represent the beginning of
a different energy environment.
Encountering a vehicle of any kind. This is your mind’s representation of a
nonphysical (formless) energy-body or vehicle
of consciousness. Often this is an image of
your own inner or higher-frequency energybody.
Experiencing a barrier or blockade (a
wall, a river, any kind of energy barrier).
A barrier is usually an energy representation
of a possible limitation you have accepted or
created yourself, it is an opportunity to
confront a personal energy block and
overcome it. A barrier can also represent a
border to a consensus environment or reality.
Observing or confronting a strange or
frightening form, creature, or being of
any kind.
Generally, frightening forms are energy
representations of inner fears—subconsciously
created opportunities for you to confront and
conquer personal fears, blocks, or limitations.
The most effective way to eliminate a problem
or fear is to face it. Sending love to fears is
one of the best ways to dissipate their energy.
Rapidly changing or shifting scenes or
environments.
This situation usually reflects a lack of focus.
To control it, simply focus on a single
environment or object. Rapidly changing
scenes may also indicate that you are in a
nonconsensus reality.
Tugging sensation at the center of your
back.
This is generally an inner signal to return to
the physical.
Entering an extremely bright or
highenergy environment (may manifest
as a high-energy crushing sensation
accompanied by in- tense light).
You have entered an energy environment with
a higher frequency than you are accustomed
to. Firmly request an adjustment of your
personal vibratory rate: “I adjust now!” “I
adapt now!” Or, return to your physical
body.
Inability to move through selective
structures.
This could represent either a personal
limitation or the boundary of a consensus
environment. Your personal energy frequency
may be too dense to penetrate the structure.
(Refer to text.)
Sudden or gradual feeling of heaviness
when flying or floating.
An inadequate percentage of your
consciousness is located within your energybody.
Firmly request your full or increased
awareness to be present.
Losing conscious control in the middle of
an out-of- body experience.
Verbally demand that your full awareness be
immediately present: “I am completely
aware now!” or “Awareness now!” (Never
mention or think about your physical body or
you will immediately return to it.)
Becoming tangled in a non- physical
item, structure, or environment
(bedclothes are the most commonly
reported item).
All physical objects have finer-frequency
energy duplicates. Remain calm and untangle
yourself, or simply float away from the
problem. This could represent an attachment
to your physical surroundings.
Dual consciousness (awareness
simultaneously in your physical body and
your non- physical energy-body).
This occurs occasionally. Since consciousness
is not physical in nature, it has the innate
ability to be aware of multiple energy areas at
the same time. Our consciousness can be
compared to a continuum of energy that
possesses the ability to move inwardly within
the nonphysical interior of the universe.
Harnessing Thought-Energy
Thought has a powerful effect on our nonphysical experience and environment,
especially thought focused in the form of a firm request. Focused thought-energy
will immediately begin to restructure and mold the surrounding nonphysical energy.
In effect, our thoughts, both conscious and subconscious, create an energy mold or
blueprint. Our thoughts interact with the subtle energy of the nonphysical
environment and begin to restructure it according to the content of our thought
patterns. You will soon discover that only specific kinds of environments will
immediately respond to your thought-energy; densely formed and established
environments will be resistant to change.
The power of thought can also be harnessed for personal mobility. Feel free to
experiment with different methods of movement when out-of-body. You can easily
move by whatever method is most natural and comfortable—flying, walking,
gliding— encountering no limits except those that you impose upon yourself. When
you have adapted to your new abilities, out-of-body travel becomes an adventure
that is absolutely exhilarating. Your knowledge of the basic thought-energy
principles is essential in adapting to and controlling your nonphysical experience.
Any doubts you may have about their validity will quickly disappear after your first
out-of-body adventures.
Thought-Energy Principles
1. Thought is a form of energy.
2. Focused thought possesses the innate ability to influence, restructure, and
ultimately mold energy.
3. The less dense the energy structure or environment, the faster the restructuring
may occur.
4. The effectiveness and speed with which thought-energy restructures an energy
environment are determined by the intensity of the thought and the density of the
energy upon which it is acting.
Adapting to the Nonphysical Environment
To effectively maneuver within the nonphysical environments we encounter when
out-of-body, it is essential to understand each new nonphysical environment and its
energy principles. Successfully interacting within the subtle thought-responsive
realities requires that we recognize the creative power of our thoughts and
completely understand that we are the driving forces of our experience. There is
much to learn about the unseen dimensions, but for now the following principles
will assist in guiding our steps.
Basic Energy Mechanics
1. The nonphysical universe becomes progressively less dense in substance and
increasingly thoughtresponsive as we explore away from matter and toward the
source of energy.
2. As a form of creative energy, our thoughts have a natural tendency to interact
with and mold the nonphysical environments we encounter. In general, the farther
within the multidimensional universe we explore, the more rapid and pronounced
this thought reaction is upon the energy environment.
3. Our thoughts, both conscious and subconscious, will influence the nonphysical
energy that we observe. The degree of influence is in direct proportion to the
intensity of our thoughts and the density of our surroundings.
4. The reality perceived in a thought-responsive environment (nonconsensus or
natural) is determined by the personal energy frequency (density) of the observer
and the observer’s prevailing conscious and subconscious thoughts.
Because these principles have an overwhelming impact upon what we observe
when out-of-body, they should not be underestimated. What we see and
experience will be greatly influenced by how we interpret each nonphysical
environment and react within it.
The early out-of-body explorers exemplify these principles in action. In the Book of
Revelation, Saint John describes encounters with magnificent cities, angels, and
entities on horseback. Five centuries later, Mohammed describes himself as riding a
magnificent white stallion through what he called “the seven heavens.” It’s logical
that these explorers’ first- and fifth-century perceptions of reality influenced what
they saw when out-of-body. In other words, our religious history and beliefs were
influenced by the way the early prophets perceived and interpreted the nonphysical
environments that they experienced.
The early observations of all mystics, prophets, and saints were directly influenced
by their physical and social preconceptions of reality. Today Mohammed would
likely see himself riding in a magnificent white vehicle throughout the energy
dimensions of the universe. Instead of Saint John stating in Revelation, “I was in
the spirit,” he would likely say, “I was out-of-body.” This knowledge does not
diminish the inspired writings of our early spiritual explorers; it only provides
additional insight into the unseen meaning of these nonphysical explorations. Many
of the early spiritual leaders who influenced and molded our major religions were
out-of-body explorers. They documented their nonphysical journeys in accordance
with their cultural perceptions of reality. The Bible is full of statements such as “I
was in the spirit,” “You must be born again to enter the kingdom of heaven,” “The
spirit moved me,” and “Seek ye first the kingdom of God.” These statements are
clear references to their authors’ nonphysical (spiritual) explorations of the
universe. It’s only natural that the early explorers of the nonphysical dimensions
would call their discovery heaven; it’s certainly a fitting name for a
thoughtresponsive universe overflowing with endless energy levels of beauty and
light.
Each of us is different, and what we experience when out-of-body will vary
according to our social indoctrination and strongly held beliefs. The environments
and objects encountered when out-of-body are often perceived through the filters
of our mind. It’s essential to remember that any time you are exploring out-ofbody,
you can ask to see the true energy form of the object or environment you are
experiencing. If you become confused or have questions concerning your
observations, you can always request clarification. Keep in mind that all form is
energy; this applies to all environments, frequencies, and densities within the
universe (including the physical). The objects, situations, and environments we
perceive are shaped and formed by thought-energy for a specific purpose. Our
understanding of this basic energy principle will help us interpret and react to the
many nonphysical energy forms we encounter. I have found that self-created
nonphysical energy forms normally occur in the thought-responsive regions beyond
the first nonphysical dimension. The first inner dimension is a parallel energy
duplicate of the physical world and is a relatively stable energy environment that’s
resistant to thought-energy. Generally, perceived energy forms such as multilevel
structures, vehicles, or bodies of water are a strong indication that you have
ventured inward into the more thought-responsive areas of the multidimensional
universe.
Guides
There are three primary ways to direct and control our out-of-body experiences.
One way is to control our conscious thoughts (a difficult endeavor at best); another
way is to ask for assistance from a more expansive part of ourselves—our higher
self or soul. The third way is to request assistance from a guide or master with
whom we feel comfortable. A guide can be anyone we respect: Jesus, Buddha,
Saint Paul, a guardian angel, a saint. When we request guidance, we are often
directed to the experience that is the most favorable to our spiritual development.
Nonphysical guides are seldom visible. Instead we may experience a strong
impression or feeling of their presence. In their wisdom they understand that their
visual appearance would only distract us from our personal goal. When a guide is
present, we often experience a warm feeling of love and security surrounding us.
Within ourselves we know that we are being assisted and directed to the ideal
experience.
The advantages of a guide are numerous. In the higher-frequency worlds our needs
are transparent; our state of spiritual development, our inner blocks, limitations,
fears, and abilities are clearly evident. A nonphysical guide can appraise our
developmental needs and assist us to the situation best suited for our evolution.
The inner worlds of the universe are larger in size and diversity than our minds can
begin to comprehend; unlimited energy levels and realities are available to explore.
Without guidance it’s easy to become confused or disoriented within any thoughtresponsive
environment. Unlimited assistance is always available, but it is up to us
to make the request. Guides normally will not interfere without a specific request.
Clarity
One of the best ways to enhance your awareness when out-of-body is to
immediately focus and maintain your attention on a single idea or goal. If your
attention begins to wander or your vision becomes fuzzy or dreamlike, firmly ask
for complete clarity of your awareness. The most effective way of maintaining and
enhancing your awareness and control is to request complete clarity of
consciousness at the first sign of mental wandering. Requesting clarity of thought is
the key to prolonged out-of-body experiences. Using this technique it’s possible to
maintain an out-of-body experience for several hours. Every time your mind
wanders, simply demand clarity by saying or thinking, “Clarity now!” It is often
necessary to demand clarity immediately after separation, when moving to a new
nonphysical location, or when traveling between energy environments or
dimensions.
In the beginning, the easiest way to control and prolong your out-of-body
experiences is to acquire the habit of demanding your clarity of awareness every
few minutes. Eventually, as you gain experience, the clarity of your perceptions will
become increasingly automatic. It’s important for us to recognize that we
orchestrate our lives, both physical and nonphysical, by the power of our thoughts.
When our lives feel out of control, it’s because we have surrendered our internal
control to others or have refused to accept our personal responsibility. For many of
us, it’s easier to point the finger of blame at others than to accept responsibility for
our individual thoughts and actions. Some of the toughest lessons we are here to
learn are directly related to thought control and personal responsibility. Our ability
to focus and direct our thoughts is a central element of our personal evolution. The
benefits we receive are beyond our expectations—our life is our reward.
CLARITY TECHNIQUE
A simple exercise is extremely effective for avoiding the disjointed or hazy
awareness that some people report just after separation from the physical body.
Immediately after separation, demand your complete clarity to be present: “Clarity
now!” “I demand complete clarity!” or “Awareness now!” When making this
request, avoid any phrase that includes a reference to your physical body or
physical surroundings. For example, the statement “I demand full awareness in my
body” will immediately snap you back to your physical body.
Always remember that when you are out-of-body you are experiencing a higherfrequency,
less dense energy form and environment. Your new surroundings,
including your nonphysical body, are much more responsive to thought-energy than
the physical body. When making your request, keep it firm and specific and the
results will be immediate and effective. The stronger and more focused the request,
the more effective the results.
This technique can also be used to upgrade a lucid dream to a fully conscious outof-
body experience. The key is to repeat this procedure until the fogginess fades
and your full awareness is present. The clarity technique is a procedure I
automatically do immediately following separation from my physical body. In
addition, I repeat it anytime my vision or awareness is less than ideal. I have found
that it not only sharpens nonphysical perceptions but also enhances control and
memory recall.
Fear Reduction and Control
Fear can be an obstacle to successful out-of-body exploration. Our personal
anxieties, both conscious and unconscious, create invisible walls around us, boxing
us into a narrow comfort zone and hindering us from achieving our highest
potential. The choices we make and the lives we live are often directed by the way
we manage our individual fears.
When I was a young man, I had a high school friend who was considered one of the
finest baseball players in Baltimore. After some media attention, his coach arranged
for him to attend a major-league tryout session. But after weeks of encouragement
from his coach and fellow players he told me a secret, “I’m afraid I’ll fail, I’m just
not good enough.” He never did go to the tryout; his fear of failure was more than
he could handle. Instead of going for his dream, he surrendered to his fear.
Many believe that the very act of separating from our physical body and exploring
new realms of the universe is effective in reducing our personal fears and limits.
After an out-of-body experience, it’s common to hear people speak of their personal
breakthroughs. Sometimes this is a realization or confrontation with an inner aspect
of themselves; at other times it’s the recognition that they are much more than just
a physical creature. On a number of occasions I have had people tell me that they
had somehow connected to a more expansive part of themselves. Whatever we call
it—spirit, higher self, God, or universal mind—this connection is absolutely real to
the participant. This experience is difficult to explain, for it extends beyond our
current linear concepts of reality.
In all our lives there are pivotal moments that change our destiny. Our challenge is
to face these moments and conquer our fears. Your discovery of out-of-body
exploration may be one of these pivotal times. Your decision to explore beyond
your physical boundaries may be a decision that changes your entire life. I can only
say that it’s definitely been a turning point in my life, and I thank God that I faced
my fears and ventured forward. One thing that I have learned is that all fears are
an illusion. Each of us is an immortal being possessing unlimited potential. Our true
inner self cannot be harmed, nor can it die.
PANIC ATTACKS
During the early stages of an out-of-body exploration, some people report an
intense rush of fear similar to a panic attack. Generally, this is -caused by fear of
the unknown and the initial physiological surprise of actually separating from your
physical body. Panic attacks are often triggered by the unusual vibrations and
sounds that sometimes accompany the shift of your awareness from the dense
molecular body to your higher-energy counterpart. When first experienced, these
vibrations and sounds can be startling, so it’s important to remember that they are
a natural part of out-of-body exploration. Many times, your recognition and
understanding of these unusual sounds and vibrations are sufficient to eliminate or
reduce any anxiety that may arise.
If panic attacks are a recurring problem, a simple soft affirmation may help. At the
first sign of anxiety, repeat in your mind, “I am safe and secure” or “I am
protected.” Continue to repeat your affirmation until the fear subsides. Then follow
the regular instructions by directing yourself away from your physical body—for
example, “I move to the front door.” It’s commonly reported that after complete
separation from the physical body is achieved, the initial anxiety disappears.
Keep in mind that out-of-body experiences are a natural transfer of
consciousness—there is simply nothing to fear. This fact is verified daily by the
thousands of people who have out-of-body experiences.
Generally, panic attacks cease to be a problem after you have had a successful
experience. At that point, you know for yourself that there is nothing to fear.
FEAR-REDUCTION TECHNIQUE
If fear continues to be a recurring issue, this technique will be helpful.
1. Identify the fear. Attempt to identify the nature of your fear. For example, are
you afraid of the unknown? Of rapid change? Of the possibility of becoming lost?
Your recognition of your fear is an excellent indicator of progress.
2. Use the fear. Fear is a form of energy. It increases your respiration, strength,
and ability to concentrate. It’s nature’s energy boost, designed to enhance your
capacity to deal with potential obstacles or challenges. When you feel fear, attempt
to use it to your advantage. Use the energy generated by fear to increase your
concentration and desire to achieve your personal goal of out-of-body exploration.
3. Eject the fear. Take a deep breath, as you exhale, visualize the fear being
expelled from your body, mind, and emotions. You can mentally repeat to yourself,
“My fear is moving away from me,” “My fear is gone,” “I rise above my fear,” or
“My fears are washed away.” As vividly as possible, picture the fear moving away
from you. Visualize it fading away forever.
4. Replace your fear. Replace the emotional feelings of fear with a positive,
productive energy such as exhilaration, concentration, courage, or the thrill of
adventure. Use an appropriate affirmation such as “I am safe and secure,” “I enjoy
my new adventure,” or “Excitement flows through me.”
HOT-AIR-BALLOON VISUALIZATION
The following visualization technique may assist you in overcoming fear and other
obstacles to a successful out-of-body experience.
Take several deep breaths and completely relax. Begin to visualize a majestic,
bright orange, hot-air balloon. As you approach the balloon, you can clearly see
that it’s ready for liftoff. The familiar smile of your guide welcomes you to another
adventure beyond the limits of matter. As you step inside the basket, you look
forward to another exciting journey. With absolute joy, you cast off the ropes
holding you to the earth. With an upward surge, your balloon begins to rise. An
intense feeling of exhilaration builds as you effortlessly rise higher and higher and
slowly drift over the treetops. Below, the homes and cars begin to look like toys—
small and insignificant.
Looking down over the edge of the balloon’s basket, you notice several large
canvas bags. The bags look extremely full and heavy. On closer inspection, you
recognize that the bags are filled with your fears and limits. Each bag is clearly
labeled: fear of the unknown, fear of change, fear of failure, fear of new challenges,
fear of death. Whatever fear or limit you currently experience in your life is clearly
marked on the bags. Take a moment and recognize your individual fears and limits
and see them hanging in the canvas bags.
As you drift above the treetops, you realize that you have stopped rising. The
weight from the bags of fear and limits is holding you back, holding you down.
Peering over the edge of your balloon, you can see that each bag is tied securely to
your basket. With overflowing joy, you begin to untie bags of fear and watch each
one plummet to earth. As each bag of fear is released, you can feel your balloon
surge upward, going higher and higher. With childlike excitement, you can feel each
fear drop away. You absolutely know that each fear is gone forever, that each
limitation is a thing of the past. Some of the bags of fear are so tightly tied that you
need to cut them free. Your guide hands you a pocketknife, and with delight you
begin cutting the tough strands of rope securing the remaining bags. As each rope
is cut, you experience your lightness and freedom expanding. You feel the thrill of
total liberation flowing through you as you go higher and higher. As you rise to new
heights, your fears and limits are gone forever.
Control Overview
• You possess the exact amount of control that you believe you do, the exact
amount that you accept and implement.
• The key to prolonging your out-of-body experience is to maintain the focus of
your attention away from your physical body. The best way to achieve this is to
become completely involved and interested in the nonphysical environment you are
exploring. As you will soon discover, any thought of your physical body will
instantly snap you back into it.
• You are the controlling cause of your experience, either consciously or
subconsciously. You are the writer, director, and actor in every experience,
situation, and encounter. This applies to all levels of the universe.
• Your method of movement is completely your decision. You can walk, float, fly, or
drift. You can change your selected method of movement at any time to suit the
situation en-countered.
• If your perception is unclear or fuzzy, you can increase the clarity of your vision
by firmly demanding an immediate improvement of your perception: “Clarity now!”
• Your nonphysical energy form is extremely flexible in size, shape, structure, and
capabilities. You will probably experience the form that is most comfortable for you.
This is generally a duplicate of your physical body. However, beyond the second
energy membrane, you have the ability to consciously adapt and change your form
to practically any shape necessary. This is achieved by concentrating upon a
change in your self-conception.
• Feelings of fear are self-generated and are generally the direct result of a lack of
information or knowledge when encountering a new situation or environment.
Always remember that you are a powerful, nonphysical being; at your essence you
are pure consciousness. You have nothing to fear, for you are immortal.
• As much as possible, attempt to maintain an open, nonjudgmental state of mind.
Strongly held opinions, beliefs, and conclusions can influence what you experience
and perceive, just as they do in the physical world.
• Remember to remain calm and centered during any changes or movement of your
awareness.
• Recognize your ability to control your movement and your experience. Your
thoughts are your personal vehicle and creative force. You simply go where your
thoughts lead.
• Firmly request what you wish to explore, achieve, or perceive and be as specific
as possible.
• Be prepared for rapid changes and/or inner motion when making requests.
• Fully expect to receive your requests—be open to receive.
• Ask for clarification if what you observe or experience is unclear. For example,
“What does this nonphysical energy form represent?”
• Exercise your control. Just do it—there is no need for hesitation or second
thoughts. Your ability to navigate in a thought-responsive environment will largely
depend on your thought control, knowledge, and personal ability to remain calm
and focused when encountering rapid change. As in all things, the more prepared
you are, the more productive the experience will be.
Always remember, you experience the degree of control you demand. Aim high.
CHAPTER 8
Advanced Explorations
Man’s mind, stretched to a new idea, never goes back to its original dimension.
—Oliver Wendell Holmes
The potential of out-of-body exploration is absolutely unlimited. After we step from
our physical limits, an exciting new frontier of human potential and exploration
becomes clear. Old limits begin to melt away as our true potential is realized.
Each of us possesses unseen, untapped abilities that modern science is only
beginning to comprehend. Controlled out-of-body experiences open the door to a
new era of human development and exploration; however, it’s up to us to explore
the reality of this for ourselves—or to remain prisoners of our physical limits.
To give you a sense of the explorations that are possible, I have included a list of
potential experiments later in this chapter. To achieve specific benefits or goals,
you can also develop and pursue your own experiments. When conducting any form
of exploration or experiments, always remember to record the results as soon as
possible. A voice-activated recorder is recommended. To get started, you could try
two experiments similar to those conducted at Stanford University’s parapsychology
facility.
The first experiment is quite easy to set up: before you begin your out-of-body
technique, place a small item such as a paper clip, pencil, or coin at the edge of a
table. During your out-of-body experience, consciously attempt to lower your
personal density (frequency) and move the object. Record the results.
The second experiment is the viewing of a remote target when out-of-body. To set
it up, have a friend select and draw a large (at least six inches in diameter)
number, picture, or symbol and place it at a location you can’t physically see. Ask
him or her to display the target in a clearly visible location with which you are
familiar, such as your friend’s home. After you separate from your physical body,
focus your complete attention on the target location and attempt to observe the
target as accurately as possible.
Exploring the Universe
When exploring beyond your physical body, the first nonphysical dimension
commonly observed is a parallel world consisting of energy many times less dense
than matter. At first glance, it appears to be a duplicate of the physical world. After
closer investigation, you will discover that this energy environment is similar to
your physical surroundings but not identical. Objects such as chairs, doors, beds,
and entire rooms will often look slightly different than they do in your physical
surroundings. The reason for these differences is simple. The objects and
environments observed within the first inner energy level of the universe are not
physical in substance. They are similar to energy molds of your physical
surroundings. Each nonphysical item you see exists completely independent of the
physical universe.
Numerous people have been led to believe that they are observing their physical
surroundings from a new vantage point. They expect their nonphysical
surroundings to be identical to their physical world, and when their expectations are
unfulfilled, they easily become confused or disoriented. As a result, some conclude
that their entire out-of-body experience was a dream, just because the
environment observed didn’t match their physical expectations. This misconception
often occurs because we are conditioned to accept only dense forms as valid. As a
result, our minds have a tendency to focus on the single reality we know and
accept—matter. Since we live in a physical environment and are immersed in a sea
of physical stimuli, this indoctrination is to be expected. Our physical conditioning is
a natural part of our socialization process. The key to overcoming this extensive
physical indoctrination is to recognize it. The physical world we focus upon is but a
tiny fraction of the universe. In reality, the physical forms we see around us are
only the thin outer crust of the universe—the epidermis layer of the entire
multidimensional universe.
Always remember that reality is relative; the environment we perceive as real is
determined by our personal density and frequency. For example, when we are outof-
body, it’s quite common for physical objects to appear vaporous and ghostlike.
This occurs because matter, as observed from a higherfrequency vantage point, is
no longer a solid reality to us. From your new perspective, the only firm reality to
you is the energy frequency (density) corresponding to your own. Your knowledge
of this energy principle is critically important when you are exploring a different
vibrational universe. This knowledge will assist you in controlling your experiences.
As you progress in your explorations, you will begin to recognize a startling truth.
You possess the power to move within the different energy areas of the universe by
the act of focused thought. You can consciously raise and lower your vibrational
(density) rate; the observed result is a corresponding change in your surrounding
environment. This discovery is significant because it practically eliminates the need
for external (lateral) movement. You can essentially explore any frequency of the
universe without moving. The physical concepts of distance, separation, and motion
become irrelevant.
A second advantage of this advanced exploration method is greater self-control. It’s
easier to remain focused when you do not have to deal with simultaneous external
and internal changes. It’s also easier to retain your sense of stability and clarity.
Third, the method allows you to explore more effectively the innumerable frequency
levels of the universe. Lateral motion within a given energy dimension is often
limited to a narrow frequency band within that dimension.
And finally, it expands your ability to explore, perceive, and comprehend beyond
current human understanding. Consciously altering your density (vibrational
frequency) provides almost unlimited access within the nonphysical interior of the
universe.
Our current concepts of motion are directly related to our physical indoctrination.
Eventually, each of us will evolve to the point where we can simply “be” in any
portion of the universe we choose. This is not a theory but an observable fact that
can be verified by personal experience.
CONTROLLED INTERDIMENSIONAL MOVEMENT
1. Immediately after separation, move away from your physical body and become
calm and centered. If necessary, request that your complete awareness or clarity
be present. “Awareness Now.”
2. While out-of-body, firmly demand to experience the next inner energy
dimension. “I experience the next inner level (dimension) now!” Or pinpoint
whatever interdimensional area you would like to explore. The immediate result will
be an intense inward motion that will last for several seconds. Remain as calm as
possible; the sensation of inner motion can be intense and disorienting if you are
unprepared. The experience is similar to being pulled inward, into the center of
your consciousness.
3. After your inner motion has ceased, immediately center yourself by firmly
requesting that your complete awareness be present. “Awareness now!” Be
prepared; your new environment and viewpoint will be completely different.
Raising Our Internal Frequency
As you progress in your exploration within the higher-frequency energy levels of
the universe, you may begin to notice changes in your state of awareness. Internal
energy sensations, visions, experiences with light, and increased energy sensitivity
are commonly reported. The environments you encounter in the higher-frequency
energy levels will become progressively more radiant with light. The very substance
of your surroundings consists of a higher form of energy. For example, when you
observe a simple flower or blade of grass you will see that it radiates an intense
spectrum of light and color. A single blade of grass appears to be made of a
thousand points of light. Each blazing point of light is pure, living consciousness.
As we explore deeper into the universe, there is a need for us to raise our internal
vibratory rate—to increase our internal light. To effectively explore the higher levels
of the universe, our vibratory rate must be adjusted to coincide with the energy
frequency we are experiencing. If our internal frequency is not equal to the new
environment we are visiting, we will experience a blinding light and a crushing
sensation of intense energy pressing upon us. This feeling is so uncomfortable that
most people immediately retreat to their physical bodies.
When exploring the higher realms of the universe, we can enhance our internal
vibrational rate by making a firm, sincere request. In effect, we can request a finetuning
of our inner energy for the enhancement of our spiritual development. This
fine-tuning of our unseen energy systems is an ongoing developmental process,
normally occurring when we’re asleep or dreaming. Most people are not consciously
aware of these inner changes as they occur. For those who are aware, these
changes are often perceived as waves of inner energy surging through the body.
This process can last for seconds or minutes, depending upon the amount of
adjustment required. I have found that the raising of our individual vibrational rate
has a major effect upon our nonphysical capabilities. It’s essential to enhance our
personal energy frequency if we are to explore the higher realms of the universe. It
is our responsibility to increase our personal light if we ever hope to escape from
the illusion of matter. Always remember that heaven will not adapt to us; we must
adapt to it.
Negative thoughts, anger, hatred, attachments, and ignorance block the natural
radiation of our internal light. Destructive thoughts and emotions are a form of lowfrequency
energy that attaches to our inner energy-body like a cloak. When out-ofbody
you can immediately spot these negative vibrations in the energy field (aura)
of anyone you are observing. Negative emotions such as hate, fear, anger, and
greed become a part of the person who creates them. This negative energy acts
like an energy-dampening field, blocking the inner light of soul from shining
through at its normal intensity.
During out-of-body exploration, the evolution of anyone you observe is clearly
evident by the intensity of light radiating from that person. The brighter the internal
light, the more evolved the individual. Raising our personal vibratory rate begins
with the removal of our internal energy blocks. This is why advanced spiritual souls
such as Jesus and Buddha spent so much time teaching the Golden Rule. “Love
they neighbor,” “Do unto others . . .“ They fully realized that the more energy
blocks we remove, the brighter our light shines and the higher our natural
frequency rate becomes in the multidimensional universe.
The recognition of this principle is important to your immediate evolution. When
your physical body dies, you will automatically go to the energy level (frequency) of
the universe that corresponds to your personal vibratory rate. As you will discover,
this is a natural energy process—the shift of consciousness from one frequency to
another. Those unique individuals who have recognized and eliminated their energy
blocks and raised their personal frequency rate will experience the full magnificence
and light of the kingdom of heaven.
Amplifying the Vibrational State
It is possible to amplify the vibrational state from a slight internal vibration to a
complete separation from the physical body. This can be accomplished by mentally
encouraging the slight vibrations to build, expand, and spread throughout the body.
It’s quite common for some of us to awaken during various stages of sleep and
experience a slight internal vibration and/or numbness at the back of the neck or in
the legs or arms. This is often experienced during REM sleep, during lucid dreams,
or during the light stages of alpha, such as the hypnagogic state. Of course, the key
to this technique is to recognize the initial vibrations and numbness when they
occur. The best way to do this is to pay attention to the subtle energy fluctuations
occurring during the initial stages of sleep, dreams, and relaxation. Awareness of
our internal sensations, feelings, and perceptions is an important first step in
noticing our internal vibrations.
From now on, immediately upon awakening or when drifting in and out of sleep,
remain physically still and completely relaxed. Notice any internal energy changes,
vibrations, numbness, tingling, or other unusual sensations. When these sensations
occur, mentally encourage the vibrations and accompanying sensations to expand
throughout your body. Flow with the sensations and allow them to spread through
your body and mind. After the vibrational sensations and numbness have spread
throughout your body, direct yourself away from your body. Maintain your complete
attention and thought away from your physical body and direct yourself to another
area of your home. As unusual as it may sound, this is a very natural thing to do.
The key is simply to notice, and then encourage, the subtle nonphysical changes
that occur within us.
Enhancing Memory Recall
Each time you end an out-of-body exploration or experiment, make a firm request
for a complete memory transfer to your physical awareness. Your physical brain
and memory function like a computer: the obtained nonphysical information must
be accurately transferred and stored within your physical consciousness. The
easiest way to accomplish this is simply to request it.
Many out-of-body explorers are unaware of this principle. The result can be a hazy,
disjointed memory of their nonphysical experiences. As in the clarity technique, the
emphasis you place upon your memory request will determine the effectiveness of
the results. A firm, focused demand works best: “I remember all!” Ideally, the
request for enhanced memory should be made when you’re ready to return to your
physical form. This request will often propel you immediately back to your physical
body.
Group and Partner Explorations
An out-of-body exploration group or partnership can provide considerable benefits
for all involved. Since out-of-body experiences are a new form of exploration in our
society, a nonphysical exploration group can offer valuable insights gained from
firsthand experiences and also provide an open forum for new perspectives and
techniques. A group enables us to compare notes and learn from each other’s
experiences. As we fine-tune our natural abilities, the important areas of fear
reduction, belief reappraisal, dream conversion, inner signals, and separation
techniques can be explored and developed based on firsthand results. The group
can also discuss and pinpoint any psychological limitations or blocks that appear.
As an added benefit, some powerful verification experiments can be conducted. For
example, a group can create a target destination: a physical time and place where
group members will meet while traveling outside their physical bodies.
In addition to group exploration, I highly recommend a buddy or partner system for
out-of-body adventures. It’s important to select someone who is serious about
inner discovery. Consciously meeting a friend or lover while out-of-body is an
incredible experience.
THE PARTNER TECHNIQUE
The partner technique is a variation of the Christos technique developed by G. M.
Glaskin, an Australian journalist. The Christos technique was originally designed as
a past-life regression method, but it was soon discovered that it initiated out-ofbody
experiences for substantial numbers of people.
The following technique is ideal for couples, partners, and groups. As the guide, you
will be leading the meditation and occasionally moving around your partner, so it’s
important for you to be as quiet as possible. Your partner lies on his (or her) back,
eyes closed, head toward the north. To be as comfortable and relaxed as possible,
he should remove his shoes and lie on a soft surface such as a bed, a floor mat, or
pillows. Now begin to gently massage your partner’s anklebones in a gentle circular
motion. The idea is to relax your partner as much as possible. After about two
minutes of the ankle massage, quietly move to your partner’s head and place four
fingers on his forehead, just above the bridge of the nose. Now slowly begin a
gentle, circular rubbing to the lower portion of the forehead. With gradually
increasing speed and pressure, continue to rub your partner’s forehead until he
reports a loud internal buzzing or humming sound. After the buzzing sound is
heard, you can stop rubbing. Most people report hearing a sound within five
minutes. Now you will begin a verbal, guided meditation. Throughout the guided
visualization, speak in a slow, relaxing tone, assisting your partner to become as
relaxed as possible. Take your time and focus on relaxation as you begin the
following guided visualization.
Take several deep breaths and completely relax . . . completely relax . . . slow
down and completely relax . . . begin to feel your inner energy flowing, . . . Feel
your inner energy slowly moving from your head down your neck . . . feel it slowly
move down through your shoulders. . . . You feel completely relaxed as your
energy moves down through your chest, . . . The energy feels good as it continues
moving down through your stomach . . . your hips . . . your thighs. . . . Now feel
the energy moving down your calves . . . feel the energy moving past your ankles .
. . you can see and feel the energy at the very bottoms of your feet, . . .
After the relaxation portion of this visualization, begin to lightly brush the bottoms
of your partner’s feet with your fingertips as you repeat the following.
Visualize the energy at your feet extending and growing four inches through the
bottoms of your soles, . . . Now you can see and feel the extension of your feet by
four inches, . . . Feel the stretch of your feet extending four inches beyond the
bottoms of your feet. . . . Now, hold that extension for a few moments.
[After each extension is successfully visualized, your partner can let you know by
nodding.] After your partner has visualized the four-inch stretch, have him imagine
the sight and sensations of his feet returning to their normal position. Now, repeat
this stretching at least three times until your partner can easily visualize a four-inch
extension of his feet. Take your time and be patient. This initial stretching is
essential to the success of this technique, so feel free to repeat it as many times as
necessary. After your partner has indicated his ability to extend his visualized feet,
quietly move to the head and repeat the same stretching exercise with the upper
body and head. (The guided visualization proceeds uninterrupted as you lightly
touch the top of your partner’s hair and shoulders.)
Now, feel your energy flowing to the top of your head, . . . Feel the top of your
head begin to extend and grow See and feel the top of your head and your upper
body expand and grow four inches, . . . See and feel your head and shoulders
growing a full four inches beyond their normal size, . . . Feel the stretch of your
entire upper body growing and expanding outward . . . a full four inches beyond its
physical limits, . . .
As before, repeat this process at least three times until your partner can easily
imagine the extension. Return your partner’s attention to his feet and verbally
guide him to extend his lower body by a full twelve inches. Repeat as many times
as necessary. Move to your partner’s head and guide him to a twelve-inch
extension of his entire upper body and then a return to normal size. Now, return to
the feet and guide your partner to a full twenty-four-inch extension. This time,
however, instruct him to hold the visualization and not return to a normal position.
After the foot extension is complete, have your partner simultaneously stretch his
upper body a full twenty-four inches. Repeat this procedure until your partner can
clearly see and feel this total stretch of his body. While the full twenty-four-inch
stretch is being maintained, direct your partner to expand his complete body like a
balloon being filled with air. For example:
Now your entire body is expanding in size, . . . You can feel your inner self expand
all over, like a balloon filling with air. . . . Your entire body is expanding all over . . .
your entire body is expanding by twenty-four inches, . . . As your body expands,
you can feel yourself getting lighter and lighter, . . . Like a balloon, you can feel
yourself rising, rising, . . .
Now your partner is in an ideal state to achieve a fully conscious, out-of-body
experience. At this point you can immediately begin a favorite out-of-body
technique. For example: As you float, you can feel yourself becoming lighter and
floating higher and higher above your body. . . . As you do, you repeat to yourself,
“I am floating. I am floating. I am aware I am floating. I am floating
free.”
If done correctly, this technique provides a powerful preparation for any out-ofbody
visualization or affirmation.
Take your time and allow your partner to enjoy all the sensations associated with
this technique. Feel free to enhance or lengthen the guided meditation to
accommodate your partner s visualization skills. Ideally, allow at least half an hour
when doing the guided visualization. After the verbal, guided portion of this
technique, allow your partner at least twenty minutes of silence to accomplish his
or her personal affirmations and visualization. Although I’ve included only one
technique designed specifically for partners, any of the visualization techniques can
be easily adapted to a partner or group situation by designating someone to do the
verbal guided visualization.
Accelerating Psychological Change and Self-Improvement
At some point in our lives we all seek a form of self-improvement or psychological
change. In the past three decades, countless self-improvement techniques, books,
rapes, and courses have become available: positive thinking, neurolinguistic
programming, inner-child work, self-talk, rebirthing, Twelve Steps, biofeedback,
and a host of others. In general, our concepts of self-improvement are still linked to
the conclusions arrived at decades ago by the founding fathers of modern
psychology. Freud, the creator of psychoanalysis, and Jung, the founder of
analytical psychology, believed that psychological change was a slow, deliberate
process. Today this conclusion is accepted by psychologists and psychiatrists
worldwide. Many consider psychological improvement to be the slow process of
peeling away the outer layers of ego so that patients can see and understand the
underlying cause of their current problems or blocks.
Every year millions of people spend considerable time and money attempting to
achieve some form of psychological change. Many have been conditioned to believe
that positive psychological change is a long, arduous road. Most psychiatrists and
psychologists expect noticeable improvements to rake from several months to
several years. A few years ago, during a conversation with a psychologist, I was
told bluntly, “Psychological change is a grueling task that takes a lifetime.” My first
thought was, “I’m glad I’m not paying you by the hour”. Studies have shown that
the attitudes and expectations of the medical practitioner dramatically affect the
results achieved; often the expectations, or lack of them, are transferred to the
patient. If a psychologist expects positive psychological change to be a grueling
lifelong task, it most certainly will.
Over the years I have found many of the basic conclusions of the billion-dollar selfimprovement
industry to be severely lacking. I believe that the time has come for
us to ask some serious questions. How can we effectively improve ourselves when
we don’t know what we are, why we’re here, and where we’re going? How can we
effectively improve something that we don’t comprehend? Do self-improvement and
positive psychological change require years of grueling introspection? I strongly
believe that it is within our grasp to bypass the unending maze of self-analysis and
cut to the heart of self-improvement. This observation is shared by a growing
number of individuals and groups throughout the world.
For a moment just imagine what could be accomplished if there were a more direct
and effective way to achieve positive psychological change and self-improvement.
Consider, for example, the experience of Michael Crichton, the internationally
known author of Jurassic Park, who describes one of his out-of-body experiences in
his autobiography Travels. He initiated this out-of-body experience with the
assistance of a personal guide and friend, Gary.
Anyway, the idea of the astral travel didn’t seem too alarming, and I tried it with
Gary. It is, after all, just another kind of guided meditation in an altered state. I
visualized my chakras glowing brightly, spinning like white spirals. Then I visualized
myself leaving through my third chakra, moving up to the astral plane—which to
me appeared as a misty yellow place.
So far, so good. I began to see why people so often imagined heaven as misty or
cloudy. This misty astral plane was agreeable. It was peaceful to be standing here,
in all this yellow mist. I felt fine.
“Do you see anybody here?” Gary asked.
I looked around. I didn’t see anybody.
“No.”
“Stay there a minute and let’s see if anybody comes.”
Then I saw my grandmother, who died while I was in medical school. She waved to
me, and I waved back.
I wasn’t surprised to see her up here. I didn’t feel any particular need to talk to her.
So I just waited around. This astral plane was rather featureless. There weren’t any
palm trees or chairs or places to sit down. It was just a place. A misty yellow place.
“Do you see anybody else?” Gary said.
I didn’t. Then: “Yes. My father.”
I felt worried. I hadn’t had an easy time with my father. Now he was showing up
while I was vulnerable, in an altered state of consciousness. I wondered what he
would do, what would happen. He approached me. My father looked the same, only
translucent and misty, like everything else in this place. I didn’t want to have a long
conversation with him. I was quite nervous. Suddenly he embraced me. In the
instant of that embrace, I saw and felt everything in my relationship with my
father, all the feelings he had had and why he had found me difficult, all the
feelings I had had and why I had misunderstood him, all the love that there was
between us, and all the confusion and misunderstanding that had overpowered it. I
saw all the things he had done for me and all the ways he had helped me. I saw
every aspect of our relationship at once, the way you can rake in at a glance
something small you hold in your hand. It was an instant of compassionate
acceptance and love. I burst into tears.
“What is happening now?” “He’s hugging me.” “What are you feeling?” “It’s ... all
over,” I said.
What I meant was that this incredibly powerful experience had already happened,
complete and total, in a fraction of a second. By the time Gary had asked me, by
the time I burst into tears, it was finished. My father had gone. We never said a
word. There was no need to say anything. The thing was completed.
“I’m done,” I said, and opened my eyes. I had bounced right out of the trance
state. I couldn’t really explain it to Gary—I couldn’t really explain it to anybody—
but part of my astonishment at the experience was at the speed with which it had
occurred. Like most people who have had therapy, I had an expectation about the
pace of psychological insights. You struggle. Things happen slowly. Years may go
by without much change. You wonder if it is making any difference. You wonder if
you should quit or hang in. You work and you struggle and you make your hardwon
gains. But what of this experience?
In less time than I took to open my mouth to speak, something extraordinary and
profound had happened to me. And I knew it would last. My relationship with my
father had been resolved in a flash. There hadn’t even been time to cry, and now
that it was over, crying seemed after-the-fact. I had no desire to cry. The
experience was already finished. This made me wonder if my ideas about the
normal speed 24 of psychological change might be incorrect.
Perhaps we could accomplish massive changes in seconds, if we only knew how.
Perhaps change took so long only because we did it the wrong way. Or perhaps
because we expected it to take so long. The following is a personal confrontation I
experienced with my own fears.
Journal Entry, September 14, 1992
I verbally repeat an affirmation, “Now I’m out-of-body,” thirty to forty times as my
body drifts to sleep. I awaken floating just above my body. I am aware of a
connection at the base of my spine and somehow visualize this attachment to be a
large insect holding me to my body. I instantly fall back into my body and break
this unusual connection. Immediately I again float upward out of my body. I feel
people touching me, gently rocking me side-to-side. I hear my mother’s voice as
she calls my name. I know I’m out-of-body but my perceptions are semi-dreamlike.
I say aloud, “Clarity now!” I feel a surge of energy and an intense sensation of
lightness and enhanced perception.
Suddenly I’m in a new environment. I’m standing in a maze of rooms completely
different from my physical home. Again I ask for clarity and receive an instant
improvement of my vision. Directly in front of me are two stairways: one goes up
into a golden-colored room; the other leads into a dark basement. As I state down
into the darkness, I see a large, slowly moving form. It appears to be headed
toward me. As it comes closer, I see the outline of a huge hairy creature, a giant
sloth, standing nine feet high; it has a bear’s head and the face of a dog. My entire
being is paralyzed with fear. I desperately want to run, but I hold my position.
Slowly, the creature climbs the stairs and wraps its huge hairy arms around my
neck and body. All I can think is, this thing can snap my neck in a heartbeat.
Suddenly the creature gives me a warm hug and licks my face like a dog. All my
fear dissipates as I realize that this ugly creature is powerless to harm me. An
intense feeling of empowerment and joy explodes through me; I feel completely
free from my fear and limits. The creature looks directly into my eyes, smiles, and
disappears. A surge of energy flows through me as I recognize a new form of
freedom—an absolute freedom from fear.
I return to my physical body with a new vision of myself. Somehow I know that I
have confronted an inner representation of my deepest, darkest fears and have
conquered them by holding firm. I feel completely empowered, absolutely knowing
that I can achieve whatever I desire. Now I realize that I can overcome my greatest
enemy—my own fears.
Controlled out-of-body experiences give us the unique opportunity to confront and
resolve the underlying energy-cause of any psychological issues we may have. The
mirror experience related in chapter 5 is another example of this process in action.
It should be emphasized that this is an advanced method of self-improvement that
can create a powerful experience of confrontation. It is not recommended for
individuals who are psychologically unstable.
Advanced Healing
Science has proved that many of the medical problems so prevalent in our society
are the direct result of our emotions and thoughts. We influence our physical bodies
by the way we use, move, and hold energy within us. For example, stomach ulcers,
skin ailments, physical addictions, and depression are often caused by our thought
and emotional patterns. Controlled out-of-body exploration gives us the opportunity
to consciously experience the unseen energy frequencies and patterns that affect
our physical body. When out-of-body we are directly experiencing our personal
energy substructure, our subtle nonphysical energy system. This gives us a
tremendous opportunity to make energy adjustments at the very core of our being.
Energy restructuring accomplished within the nonphysical energy-body must
eventually manifest changes within the outer physical body.
The following is a highly advanced technique that goes directly to the underlying
energy-cause of physical illness. Using this healing technique, it is possible to
influence and balance the unseen energies flowing within yourself or another
person. Begin by doing your favorite out-of-body technique. Immediately after
separating from your physical body, request complete clarity of awareness: “Clarity
now!” Repeat the clarity request until your consciousness is crystal clear. When
your full awareness is centered in your nonphysical body, begin to mentally and
verbally request the healing light and energy of God (the universe) to enter you.
Ask for and dearly feel the positive healing energies of the universe flowing within
you. Sincerely request the healing light of the universe to permeate every level of
your energy-body. Allow yourself to be completely immersed within the intense
healing light.
If you desire, verbally request the healing energy to be directed to a specific
person, or within a specific part of your own physical body. “I request the pure
energy of the universe to assist and heal name of person.” Or, “The healing power
of the universe flows throughout my body and mind.” When you direct your
thoughts toward your physical body, you will likely return to it. After returning to
the physical, remain still and feel the energy and light flowing through every cell
and system in your body. Take your time and welcome the energy flow into your
entire body. Feel the vibrational adjustments necessary for you to obtain your
optimum health. Be open to receive. Be open to a complete adjustment of your
body’s vibrational rate. It’s important that you are open to receive your request—so
many times people ask for things without being open to receive them. “I am open
to receive the healing energy within me.” This is a powerful request at any level of
the universe.
Be thankful for your experience. You have received a special gift of energy
awareness, adjustment, and healing. Use your gift to assist others to recognize and
awaken the inner healing energy that flows through all of us. During the initial
phases of this technique, remain as detached as possible toward your physical
body. Any focused thought directed toward your physical form will instantly snap
you back to your body. Don’t underestimate the power of this technique. This form
of nonphysical energy adjustment is the true cause of all physical miracles
throughout recorded history. The person doing this technique is acting as an open
channel for the power of God; within this state of consciousness, all things are
possible.
Accelerating Our Spiritual Growth
For hundreds of millions of people around the world, the ultimate goals of spiritual
development are selfrealization and God realization. These spiritual goals are
known by various names in different cultures: Christ consciousness, enlightenment,
spiritual union, oneness with God, and illumination. Since the dawn of time,
spiritual seekers, monks, prophets, and saints have spent their lives attempting to
experience these goals. Unfortunately, our modern religions have wandered from
their rich heritage of spiritual experience. Tragically, many modern religions and
churches have become a poor reflection of the original spiritual experiences and
teachings upon which they were built. The concept of personal spiritual experience
has become an unexplored 2 5 and mysterious phenomenon unknown to many
religious leaders and their churches. As a result, millions of people settle for
manmade beliefs and interpretations of their scriptures.
Today, we no longer need to depend upon the interpretations and beliefs of others.
Using out-of-body exploration, we can obtain and verify for ourselves the spiritual
answers we seek. As you will soon discover, one of the fastest and most direct
ways to experience your spiritual essence and obtain firsthand knowledge of
heaven is to learn out-of-body exploration. Controlled out-of-body experiences give
us the unique ability to achieve any spiritual goal upon which we focus. The
spiritual power of this is absolutely verifiable, but it is up to you to take action; it is
up to you to take the steps and move beyond the limits of your physical body.
In the physical world it’s easy to become lost in the dense illusions and ignorance
around us. It’s easy to become immersed in the sea of man-made beliefs,
doctrines, and traditions; it’s easy to be trapped in the physical labyrinth. Those
who truly seek spiritual growth and wisdom soon discover that it is not found in the
external world. Spiritual growth is an internal journey of awareness, a journey deep
within ourselves to the essence of our being. Spiritual growth is the personal
experience and knowledge of our true self, our very soul.
The following technique is highly recommended for anyone seeking accelerated
spiritual development, knowledge, and answers.
ADVANCED SPIRITUAL TECHNIQUE
Begin by doing your favorite out-of-body technique. Immediately after separation
from your physical body, firmly request clarity, “Clarity now!” When you are fully
aware and centered within your nonphysical body, ask to experience your soul
(higher self). Make this request a firm verbal demand for immediate action. “I
experience my soul (higher self) now!”
Instantly, you will be propelled within yourself at tremendous speed. The sensation
is one of extreme inner movement, like being drawn into a powerful vacuum deep
within yourself. Endless layers of light and color flash by your awareness as you’re
pulled deeper and deeper within. (Some people report a sensation of shooting
upward into space.) After several intense seconds, this motion will come to an
abrupt halt. Be prepared. When first experienced, this rapid inner motion of our
awareness can be startling; hold on, have faith, and remain as calm as possible. I
believe the experience of inner or upward motion is the transfer of our awareness
from our relatively dense nonphysical body to the higher-frequency existence of
pure consciousness (soul).
The result of this technique is beyond all expectations. You will experience and
know your true self, independent of all form and substance. Limits melt away as an
incredible spiritual dimension of pure light and knowledge opens within you.
Experiencing your higher self (soul) is the very heart of spiritual development; now
you have a tremendous opportunity to discover the answers to the oldest mysteries
of your existence. You can receive an answer or solution to any physical challenge
or limitation you may currently experience. Within this state of awareness, miracles
can be achieved. Your ability to comprehend and influence the denser levels of the
universe is magnified beyond all human comprehension.
Don’t underestimate the power of this technique; the conscious experience of being
your true self is an awakening that will change your life. While in this state of
consciousness, your ability to obtain answers is unlimited; you experience your
spiritual essence beyond all physical concepts of time, space, and form. You finally
know the greatest mystery of your existence—what you truly are.
Out-of-Body Experiments and Explorations
• Observe, investigate, and explore the unseen energy substructure of the
universe.
• Investigate your new environment: its form, substance, solidity, and stability.
• Conduct experiments using thought-energy; closely observe changes in your
environment.
• Travel to a friend’s or relative’s home and observe the environment and activities.
Record the time and place for verification.
• Conduct experiments with your nonmolecular density. Attempt to increase or
decrease your body’s density. Apply pressure on your arm. Can you feel it?
• Touch an object in your new environment. Can you feel it? Does in have density,
or does your hand pass through it?
• Ask to visit and communicate with a “passed on” loved one.
• Closely observe the energy structure of your “new body.”
• Conduct experiments with nonmolecular energy. Observe cause and effect,
inertia, gravity, and the unique energy forces that exist in the new environment.
• While out-of-body, observe your prevailing thoughts. Do they affect the
environment around you in any way? Now, focus upon a single thought. How does
your concentration affect the environment?
• Ask for a specific quality such as increased comprehension, vision, or
understanding. Observe any changes in your perception ability.
• Scan the horizon. How far can you see? Are there changes to the environment as
you look around?
• Request a specific form, such as a chair, to appear in front of you. Does it? If so,
does this object possess three-dimensional density? Now, ask this object to
disappear. Does it?
• Investigate the possibilities of space exploration without the limits of a
conventional spacecraft.
• Travel to your favorite physical location and observe and record the environment
and events.
• Explore the possibility of your past lives.
• Meet and communicate with a nonphysical guide or resident.
• Explore the existence of sex in a different vibrational state.
• Ask to experience your higher self, your soul (highly recommended).
• Observe your life—past, present, and probable future—from a more expansive
viewpoint.
• Ask to understand and resolve a physical problem that is causing you difficulty.
• Observe and explore the primal source of matter as we know it.
• Ask for insight into or clarification of any difficult question.
• Ask to observe the source and purpose of your current reality.
• Ask to see and communicate with a biblical angel.
• Explore and experience “heaven”—the nonphysical vibrational levels of the
universe.
• Experiment with the transmission of healing energy to a physically ill friend or
associate. Observe and record the results.
• Closely observe the connection between your energy-body and your physical
body. Is there any visible connection?
• Firmly ask to see the true essence of the energy forms around you. Observe any
changes in your environment.
• Ask to observe a thought—its form, function, and characteristics.
• Ask any question and be prepared to “experience” the answer.
• Observe your physical body from a more expansive perspective.
• Experience, explore, and begin to chart the multidimensional universe.
• Manipulate energy (form) by the conscious focus of your thought.
• Explore with a partner or mate (a highly recommended verification experience).
• Ask to observe the birth of a child from a nonphysical perspective.
• Explore the possibilities of time travel and the possibilities of sequential time and
sequential existence.
Questions About Our Existence
Throughout recorded history, every great exploration and discovery started with a
simple question: What is on the other side of the ocean? What is on the other side
of our solar system? Now, with increasing intensity, we are asking deeper
questions. What is on the other side of matter? What kind of energy and life exists
just beyond our current technological vision? Out-of-body exploration raises many
questions—so many that the list could fill a book. Here, I present a small sampling
of questions that I believe serious out-of-body explorers can answer if they are
willing to devote the necessary time and energy. These questions make excellent
research and exploration areas for out-of-body partners or research groups. The
questions are endless, but so are our potential abilities to discover answers when
we transcend our temporary physical vehicles.
What do the nonphysical environments look like?
What is their structure?
Why are only some of these environments thought-responsive?
Does a universal form of nonphysical government exist?
Are there laws or rules?
Are there penalties for breaking rules?
Does a universal nonphysical police force exist?
What are angels?
Is there a nonphysical or spiritual hierarchy?
Does God directly interact or communicate with nonphysical inhabitants?
How do nonphysical inhabitants live?
What is their normal day like?
Is it anything like physical existence?
Do cities, towns, communities, or nations exist?
Do cultures, ethnic groups, or races continue to exist?
How do the energy centers (chakras) of our body affect or influence our daily life?
How do our energy centers and nonphysical bodies function as a complete energy
system?
What is the correlation between the energy centers and our ability to have out-ofbody
experiences?
Can our energy-body assume any shape or form?
Are physical disease and illness the molecular result of unseen nonphysical energy
disturbances?
At what point during pregnancy does consciousness (soul) enter the fetus?
Does this vary from person to person or is it universal?
Can physical diseases or illnesses be healed or improved by making energy
adjustments to the nonphysical substructure of an individual?
Can a future event or disaster be averted or altered by influencing and adjusting
the unseen energy substructure of the universe?
Can future physical events be accurately analyzed, interpreted, and predicted by
observing the energy interactions existing within the interior of the universe?
Can we travel in time when out-of-body?
Is it possible that events in time are simultaneous?
Is reincarnation a reality?
Is it an evolutionary system?
How does it function?
Do angels actually exist?
If so, what do they look like?
What is their function?
Are they a nonhuman species?
Do the biblical heavens exist?
What does heaven really look like?
How many heavens are there?
How do they differ from one another?
Is the biblical heaven the inner energy dimensions of the universe?
Does God interact with human evolution or is it an automatic system of
development?
What is our true form or essence, if any?
Why are we using these temporary biological bodies?
What do we hope to learn or gain?
What does the interior of the universe look like?
What is it made of?
Is it a series of energy dimensions?
Is there a distinguishable border between the different energy dimensions?
If so, what is this border?
How does it function?
What is its purpose?
What are miracles?
Are they the alteration and restructuring of the nonphysical energy substructure of
the universe?
What do people look like when they sleep or dream? Do they float slightly above
their bodies?
Are dreams internal creations or our unconscious interpretations of nonphysical
events?
Do dreamers normally separate from their physical body?
How does our species’ evolution correlate with out-of-body experiences?
Are out-of-body experiences an evolutionary step for our species?
Is evolution actually the movement of consciousness from simply physical
organisms to increasingly complex nonphysical states of being?
What actually occurs at physical death?
Where do we go?
Is death a natural part of our evolution?
Why are we here?
Do we have a specific (unconscious) goal or plan on which we are working?
Did we select our parents?
If so, why and how?
Does nonphysical food exist and is it necessary for survival?
Do physical-like families and relationships continue after death?
Does physical-like sex exist?
Are nonphysical babies conceived?
The questions are endless. The answers are simply waiting for us to expand our
vision beyond the dense molecular crust of the universe. This is not a theory but an
evolutionary fact of 0ur existence. For many of us, the time has come to take a
step beyond the physical limits we see around us. This step is the logical transition
and evolution each of us will experience in the near future.
Questions and Comments
¬ Can out-of body experiences be proved?
Out-of-body experiences can be proved only by the participant. The ivory-tower
conclusions held by many researchers are completely archaic and meaningless in
the light of a single Personal experience. Many people desperately attempt to fit
this unique state of consciousness into their accepted model of reality. For example,
several scholars have concluded that out-of-body experiences are actually lucid
dreams; their conclusions conveniently fin their traditional concepts of the mind.
¬ What does it feel like to separate from your physical body?
Many people report a high-energy vibrational feeling and temporary physical
numbness during separation; this is often accompanied by an intense buzzing,
humming, or roaring sound. These sounds and sensations normally dissipate after
separation is complete.
¬ What does the out-of body environment look like?
The environment perceived depends upon the vibrational frequency (density) of the
participant. Many people report a physical-like environment. This environment does
not necessarily correspond to their immediate physical environment.
¬ How long does it take to have an out-of body experience?
Each person is different; however, a large percentage of people who practice daily
techniques report an experience in less than thirty days.
¬ Why should I invest my time and effort in out-of body exploration?
The only way to know something absolutely is to experience it for yourself;
anything less is theory, speculation, and belief. Out-of-body exploration offers us
the unique opportunity to experience and explore beyond the limits of our physical
senses. It gives us the ability to obtain firsthand knowledge of our existence.
¬ What will my “new” body look like?
Most people report a higher-energy duplicate of their physical body. The form we
experience is a direct result of our expectations and beliefs. In general, most
people will see themselves as they appear in the physical world.
¬ Will I be able to see, hear, and feel as I do now?
In your early out-of-body explorations, you will most likely experience your
surroundings with a physical-like perception. Our perception capabilities are linked
to our expectations; the more open we are to expanded perceptions beyond our
physical senses, the more available these enhanced capabilities become. For
example, some people report 360-degree vision, enhanced hearing, and the ability
to read thoughts. During my out-of-body experiences I sometimes feel out of sync
and have difficulty seeing or moving.
¬ How can I overcome this limitation?
This is commonly reported. To increase your clarity and mobility, simply demand
(verbally or mentally) that your complete awareness be present: “Complete
awareness now!” or “Clarity now!” Whatever personal ability or perception you need
to improve your out-of-body experience can be obtained by making a firm request.
Repeat your request as often as needed, and remember to make each request a
firm demand for immediate results.
¬ Will an out-of body experience change my religious beliefs?
According to an in-depth study of 350 participants published in 1992 by Dr. Melvin
Morse, “Out-of-body experiences do not seem to alter one’s professed values.”
Many people even report that their religious beliefs have been confirmed and
strengthened by their out-of-body experiences.
¬ What is the radiant light so often reported during a near-death experience?
This is the higher-frequency light of the inner dimensions being seen by someone
not accustomed to its brilliance. The light is commonly seen emanating from the
entrance to a tunnel.
¬ What is the human aura?
The aura is the energy field that emanates from all life-forms.
¬ What is the tunnel effect commonly reported during near-death experiences?
This is the opening of the first inner energy membrane. It occurs automatically
when a person dies and moves to the interior of the multidimensional universe. The
tunnel immediately closes after the individual passes through into the next
dimension.
¬ Does the biblical silver cord exist?
The biblical concept of the silver cord is accurate. According to my observations, it
is not actually a cord but a thin, fibrous substance similar in appearance to a
spider’s web. The silver cord appears to function as the connection between the
physical body and the first inner energy-body of all life-forms. Though its complete
function is unknown, it’s logical that it may act as an inner energy conduit. One
thing is certain, when the cord is severed, the biological life ends.
¬ Do animals have souls?
Absolutely. Without a soul (conscious energy) no living creature can exist. To be
more accurate, the soul possesses and uses a biological vehicle, not vice versa.
¬ What is the purpose of physical existence?
Physical existence allows us to learn from experience. In a sense, the physical
dimension is a slowed-down molecular environment ideally suited for the training of
developing consciousness. The personal challenges we encounter in our biological
life are the lessons we need for our personal development. We learn by being, by
doing—by firsthand experience.
¬ How can I determine the dimension or energy level I am exploring?
In general, the more similar the immediate environment is to your physical
surrounding, the closer you are to the physical dimension. As you raise your
vibratory rate, you will automatically move inward within the nonphysical
dimensions. The perceived environments become progressively less dense and
increasingly thought-responsive as you move inward away from matter.
¬ Can out-of body experiences be harmful?
No. They are a natural experience reported in every culture and society of the
world. In over twenty years of personal research, I have never heard of anyone
being harmed or injured in any way.
¬ Can drugs be used to induce an out-of body experience?
The key to a valid, productive out-of-body experience is absolute mental focus and
control. Without complete control, the interdimensional realities experienced during
out-of-body explorations cannot be accurately distinguished from self-created
internal hallucinations or imagery. Control is the key to a productive, meaningful
experience, and control is the first thing lost when using any kind of mind-altering
substance. I strongly believe that nonphysical explorers should not use drugs. Why
contaminate your biological vehicle when effective results can be achieved
naturally?
¬ Is it possible that I won’t be able to find my way back to my physical body?
No. In thousands of reported experiences there is no documented evidence of such
an occurrence. We instantly return at the slightest thought of our physical body.
¬ Can my body or mind be possessed when I leave it?
No. There is always an interactive energy connection between your physical body
and your inner energybodies.
¬ What is the church’s official viewpoint on out-of body experiences?
The Christian church does not have an official or unified viewpoint concerning outof-
body exploration. I have encountered a wide variety of opinions on this subject.
Many theologians consider out-of-body experiences a unique spiritual blessing—a
personal confirmation of their religious faith and beliefs. others are perplexed and
uncertain where such experiences may fit in their belief system. A few are inclined
to fear any phenomenon they don’t understand, and automatically classify out-ofbody
experiences as something to be avoided. Today, increasing numbers of
theologians consider out-of-body explorations to be a profound spiritual experience
and solid personal verification of immortality.
¬ Every time I feel I’m about to separate from my body, a wave of intense fear
overwhelms me. How can I overcome this?
This wave of fear is a common, instinctual response to a new experience. One of
the best ways to overcome it is to immediately begin repeating a safety affirmation
such as “I’m safe and secure,” “I’m protected,” or “I’m safe and calm.” Any brief,
positive statement that helps you relax and feel secure will be effective. As you
repeat your affirmation, begin to direct your attention away from your body. This
can easily be achieved by thinking about another area in your home or by saying to
yourself, “I float away from my body.” After a couple of successful experiences,
your fear will diminish and eventually disappear.
¬ Is out-of body exploration safe for everyone?
Yes, with one exception. Anyone who has acute psychological problems should
avoid this form of exploration. In general, people having difficulty dealing with their
physical reality can only complicate the situation by introducing other realities into
their lives.
¬ What is the most important step in gaining full, conscious control of the out-of
body experience?
The key is to repeat the clarity technique whenever your awareness is hazy or out
of sync. “Clarity now!” or “Awareness now!”
¬ What is the difference between dreams and out-of body experiences?
The difference is quite dramatic to the participant. During an out-of-body
experience, the participant is often as conscious as you are now. Dreams, on the
other hand, are experienced as a rapidly changing motion picture projected within
your awareness. At least three factors not found in a dream are normally present in
an out-of-body experience: your ego self-awareness is present; you consciously
control your movement; and you can consciously verify your experience.
Conclusion
The enormous potential of controlled out-of-body exploration may well be the most
important discovery of the twentieth century. Only by exploring beyond our
physical limits can we ever hope to comprehend the essence of ourselves and our
universe. Eventually, our species will evolve beyond dependence on physical
vehicles and technology. Until then, the progressive explorers will be those
courageous individuals who go beyond the limits of science, religion, and their
physical perceptions.
An unquenchable desire for knowledge is propelling a select number of explorers
beyond the security of their physical homelands. These resourceful adventurers are
exploring and charting the universe beyond the dense, outer crust of matter. This
exploration and charting of our unseen energy universe are of worldwide
importance. Only nonphysical exploration can pierce the dense, outer layer of
matter and expose the invisible, underlying structure of our universe.
It’s time we recognize that the decaying molecular forms we see around us are not
the only reality in the universe. It’s time we know the truth that lies behind the
molecular facade of life.
Just beyond our vision exist vast realms of energy and life waiting to be discovered.
As the twenty-first century approaches, the time has come for us to explore and
discover the truth of our existence—to break free from the conclusions and
assumptions of others, to see and know for ourselves.
Each of us faces an important choice. We can remain complacent, hoping and
praying that our beliefs are accurate, or we can make a decision to explore and
discover for ourselves. Ask yourself, what can you possibly lose by expanding your
vision and comprehension beyond the limits of matter?
Your decision to explore will mold your future, your evolution, and your life beyond
all expectations. All of us possess the God-given ability to explore and discover the
answers for ourselves. The answers are never hidden, but are patiently awaiting
our recognition and discovery. The inner search for the answers to our existence is
the very essence of human growth and evolution. No one can hand you this or
quote it from a book. An exciting new frontier of exploration is before you—endless
levels of energy just waiting to be discovered. Today you have the rare opportunity
to be one of the pioneers, to explore beyond the dense outer crust of the universe
and see the truth for yourself. The ultimate adventure is waiting, and you have
nothing to lose but your limits.
GLOSSARY
Affirmations: Repeated positive statements spoken, thought, or written in the
present tense. For example, “Now I’m out-of-body!”
Apparitions: Nonphysical inhabitants who have lowered the personal frequency of
their energy-bodies and are temporarily visible within the physical world.
Aura: The energy field emanating from all life-forms.
Black holes: Interactive energy conduits between the physical and nonphysical
dimensions.
Cataleptic: The experience of being unable to move the physical body. This
sometimes occurs during separation from and return to the physical body. It is a
temporary condition resulting from our energybody being out of phase with our
physical body. Physical sensations generally return within a minute or less.
Cluster experiences: Multiple out-of-body experiences occurring in a series. This
is a normal experience and is similar to slipping in and out of body. Cluster
experiences are commonly reported during physical illness and when physical death
is close.
Consciousness continuum: Consciousness extending its awareness from the
nonphysical source through numerous energy frequencies until it eventually
expresses itself within the outer physical dimension.
Consensus environments: Areas of the universe created and sustained by the
group consciousness of a large number of nonphysical inhabitants. These
environments are resistant to individual thought-energy.
Energy-body: A general term referring to the nonphysical or spiritual form we
experience when out-of-body. Energy-bodies are necessary for consciousness
(soul) to function within the various nonphysical frequencies of the universe.
Energy dimensions: Distinct and stable energy systems or frequencies of the
universe; separate universes of energy existing at defined frequency rates. Energy
dimensions are separated from one another by their individual and unique
vibrational frequencies. For example, the physical universe is a single energy
dimension.
Energy environment: A general term used to describe a specific nonphysical area
within a dimension. Countless energy environments can exist within a single
dimension.
Energy membrane: The convergence point of two different energy systems
(frequencies of energy); the energy border or barrier separating two energy
dimensions or systems.
First energy-body: The nonphysical form often experienced while out-of-body.
This energy form, although invisible to current technology, exists closest in density
and frequency to the physical body. Commonly referred to in traditional
metaphysical literature as the astral or etheric body.
Human radiation: A distinct feeling of energy emanating from a nonphysical
human being when out-of-body.
Hypnagogic state: The subtle state of consciousness experienced between waking
awareness and sleep. We pass through this creative state, in which mental imagery
is especially vivid, every time we go to sleep.
Lucid dream: A dream in which a degree or percentage of awareness is present.
Multidimensional universe: The entire universe, seen and unseen; a continuum
of energy consisting of an unknown number of energy frequencies or levels. As we
explore inwardly away from matter, the inner, nonphysical energy dimensions
become progressively less dense and increasingly thought-responsive. The visible
physical universe is the dense outer molecular crust of the entire universe.
Natural energy environments: Unformed energy areas currently unaffected by
thought. They are easily manipulated by conscious and subconscious thoughtenergy.
Near-death experience: An experience reported by millions of people who are
declared clinically dead
and then resuscitated. They often experience a separation from their physical body,
movement through a tunnel leading to a bright light, and a new environment.
Nonconsensus environments: Nonphysical areas of the universe that appear formed
and developed bum are currently not sustained and supported by conscious energy.
They readily respond to individual focused thought.
Nonhuman radiation: Unique and distinctive energy emanations originating from
nonphysical beings who have never had a physical human experience.
Nonphysical inhabitants: Any living beings existing within the nonphysical
dimensions without current physical bodies.
Out-of-body experience (O.O.B.E. or O.B.E.): The separation of consciousness
from its temporary biological vehicle. Also commonly called astral, etheric, or
mental projection.
Physical life-forms: Temporary cellular vehicles (biological life) used by
consciousness (soul) for expression within the dense outer dimension of the
universe. Physical vehicles are required to experience, explore, and interact within
the physical dimension, just as nonphysical vehicles are required to experience and
explore within the nonphysical dimensions.
Physical universe (dimension): The visible universe; the dense outer crust of
the complete multidimensional universe. The physical dimension makes up but a
small fraction of the entire universe (less than 1 percent).
Second energy-body: A second energy form, less dense than the first energybody,
existing at a higher (finer) frequency than the first nonphysical body. Its
internal frequency corresponds to the second inner energy dimension.
Silver cord: The traditional biblical term for the nonphysical connection between
the first inner energybody and the biological body. In many respects, it is similar to
an energy umbilical cord capable of stretching for immense distances. In
appearance, though, it is not cordlike but is observed as thin, fibrous filaments
connecting the biological body to its densest nonphysical counterpart.
Soul: Pure consciousness existing independent of all energy-bodies or forms; the
pure essence of all life-forms. Soul exists beyond all form and substance as we
know it but uses forms of energy for its expression in the denser regions
(dimensions) of the universe. Our current physical body is one of these temporary
energy-bodies used by the soul to experience, explore, and perceive within this
dense outer
dimension of the universe.
Thought forms: Nonphysical energy formed by thought. These forms, which may
appear as anything we can imagine, are often responsive to focused thoughtenergy.
The density and longevity of thought forms vary dramatically; without
continuing thought reinforcement, they slowly decay and revert to natural clouds of
nonphysical energy.
Thought transference: The universal communication method used within the
nonphysical dimensions. This communication is commonly experienced as an
internal recognition of a progression of vivid images entering the mind. These
images can convey emotions and thought simultaneously.
Tunnel experience: The temporary opening of an energy membrane. This energy
opening is often reported during a near-death experience.
Vibrational state: Internal vibrations and sounds often reported during the
preliminary stages of an out-of-body experience. Buzzing and humming sounds
accompanied by electrical-like vibrations, numbness, and catalepsy are commonly
reported.
Visualization: The process of creating mental imagery for a specific purpose.
OUT-OF-BODY SURVEY
An overwhelming need exists for greater insight into out-of-body experiences. The purpose
of this survey is to obtain as much data as possible about nonphysical experiences and the
environments observed. Your participation in this survey will help to expand our knowledge
about the out-of-body phenomenon. Send your responses to William Buhiman, P.O. Box 515,
Bel Air, MD 21014.
Name_____________________________________________
Address (optional)__________________________________
Sex: M F
Date of birth:____________________________
RACE OR ETHNIC GROUP CURRENT MARITAL STATUS
_____ White _____ Single
_____ Black _____ Married
_____ Hispanic _____ Remarried
_____ Native American _____Separated
_____ Asian _____ Divorced
_____ Other (please specify) _____ Widowed
CURRENT RELIGIOUS PREFERENCE/ AFFILIATION EDUCATIONAL LEVEL
_____ Catholic _____ Grade school
_____Protestant _____ Some high school
_____ Jewish _____ High school graduate
_____ Muslim _____Some college or presently
_____ Buddhist _____attending college
_____ Other (please specify) _____ College graduate
_____ None _____ Some postgraduate work
_____ Earned advanced degree (please specify)
Current occupation_____________________________________________
1. Please describe your out-of-body experience in detail, including your feelings, thoughts,
and actions.
2. At what time of day did the experience occur?
3. What physical position was your body in during your out-of-body experience? Lying down?
Reclined in an easy chair? Were you lying on your back or side? Please describe.
4. How would you describe your emotional and mental state before and during the
experience?
5. Was your physical body asleep when the experience occurred?
6. How did you leave your physical body? Rolling out, floating, spinning, sitting up? Please
describe.
7. Did you experience any feelings of fear or anxiety?
8. Did you feel any internal sensations or hear any sounds before or during the experience?
Please describe.
9. Has the experience changed your perception of life and death?
10. Do you feel that the experience has provided evidence or proof that you continue beyond
your physical body?
11. Did your state of consciousness differ from your normal physical awareness? If so, how?
12. Did you see and touch your “new” body? Did your body possess density and form?
13. Could you touch or move through obstacles such as walls and doors? If so, what did it
feel like? What did these structures look like when you were out-of-body?
14. How did your experience differ from a dream?
15. Did you enjoy the experience? Would you like to do it again?
16. Do you feel the experience has changed you? If so, how?
17. Have you received any physical or psychological benefits from your experience? If so,
please describe.
18. Has the experience changed your understanding of your existence? How?
19. Did you see or experience a tunnel, door, or opening of any kind?
20. Did you have a dream before your out-of-body exploration?
21 Did you have any difficulty adapting to your new environment?
22. How long did your experience last? Did you notice any difference between the
experienced time and the physical time?
23 How many days or attempts did it rake for you to have an out-of-body experience?
24. Have you conducted any of the experiments or explorations introduced in chapter 8?
Please describe.
25. Did you encounter any other life-forms during your experience?
26. Did you observe your sleeping physical body?
27. Describe in detail what the nonphysical environment looked like. What forms, colors,
densities, and lighting did you experience? How did the environment compare with your
physical surroundings?
28. How clear were your vision and awareness during your experience? Did you do the clarity
technique? If so, what was the result?
29. How long was your physical body asleep before your out-of-body experience?
30. Which out-of-body technique is the most effective for you?
31. Did you experience an impenetrable barrier or wall?
32. Describe your nonphysical body—its form, substance, and capabilities.
33. Did your thought processes, personality, or ego differ from your physical state of
consciousness? Please describe in detail.
34. Did you notice an increased sensitivity to electrical systems, equipment, watches,
computers, TV’s, lights, and so on, after your out-of-body experience?
PERMISSIONS
Grateful acknowledgment is made for permission to reprint excerpts and art from
the following:
Travels by Michael Crichton. Copyright © 1988 by Michael Crichton. Reprinted
by permission of Alfred A. Knopf, Inc. Text and two diagrams (pp. 81, 82) from
Parallel Universes by Fred Alan Wolf. Copyright © 1988 by Fred Alan Wolf (New
York: Simon & Schuster).
The Astronomers by Donald Goldsmith. Copyright © 1991 by Donald
Goldsmith. Reprinted by permission of Sr. Martin’s Press, Inc. QED: The
Strange Theory of Light and Matter, by Richard Phillips Feynman. Copyright
© 1985. Reprinted by permission of Princeton University Press. Diagrams from
Black Holes by Jean-Pierre Luminer (pp. 83, 99, 104). Copyright © 1987,
1992. Reprinted by permission of Cambridge University Press.
Relativity by Albert Einstein. Copyright © 1961, and Ideas and Opinions by
Albert Einstein. Copyright © 1954. Reprinted by permission of Crown Publishers,
Inc.
William Blake, Jacob’s Ladder. Copyright British Museum.
Gustave Dore, The Empyrean (frontispiece). Copyright ©1976. Reprinted by
permission of Dover Publications, Inc.